Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
OWNER’ S MANUAL
L200
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Table of contents
Overview
General information
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
For pleasant driving 5
For emergencies 6
Vehicle care 7
Maintenance 8
Specifications 9
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
11. Bonnet release lever p. 8-03
12. Fuses p. 8-20
13. Active stability control (ASC) OFF switch Type 2* p. 4-48
14. Headlamp levelling switch* p. 3-32
15. Active stability control (ASC) OFF switch Type 1* p. 4-48
Rear differential lock switch* p. 4-35
16. Outside rear-view mirrors switch* p. 4-10
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
11. Active stability control (ASC) OFF switch Type 2* p. 4-48
12. Fuses p. 8-20
13. Bonnet release lever p. 8-03
14. Fuel tank filler door release lever* p. 02
15. Steering wheel height adjustment p. 4-09
16. Hands-free & voice recognition switches* p. 5-51
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
15
15. Ashtray p. 5-70
7
8
14
13 12 11 10 9
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
15
14
13
12 11 10 9
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
17 USB input terminal* p. 5-67
16 8 9. Ashtray (fixed position)* p. 5-70
10. Cigarette lighter p. 5-71
15 10 11. Rear retractable power window switch* p. 1-08
9 12. Transfer shift lever (4WD only) p. 4-26, 4-30
14 11 13. Parking brake lever p. 4-07
14. Cup holder p. 5-78
12 15. Ashtray (moveable)* p. 5-70
13
16. Front console box* p. 5-76
17. Heated seat switch* p. 2-06
18. Gearshift lever* p. 4-15
Selector lever* p. 4-17, 4-21
19. Audio* p. 5-13
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
11. Cup holder p. 5-78
17 9 12. Ashtray (moveable)* p. 5-70
13. Gearshift lever* p. 4-15
10 Selector lever* p. 4-17, 4-21
14. Front console box* p. 5-76
15. Cigarette lighter p. 5-71
16 16. Rear retractable power window switch* p. 1-08
17. Glove box p. 5-76
13 Front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch p. 2-30
15 11 USB input terminal* p. 5-67
18. Front passenger’s airbag OFF indication lamp p. 2-31
14 12
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE:*1- Tools differ according to the vehicle model.
14
13
12
8
10 9
11
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
7 NOTE:*1- Tools differ according to the vehicle model.
14
13
12 11
10
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
18 9 13. Secret box p. 5-77
14. Rear seat* p. 2-07
17 15. Floor console box p. 5-76
Accessory socket p. 5-72
Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA)* p. 5-39
Auxiliary Video connector (RCA)* p. 5-39
16 16. Jack p. 6-07
10 Jack handle p. 6-07
Tools p. 6-07
11 17. Head restraints p. 2-08
15 18. Coat hook* p. 5-80
19. Seat belts p. 2-09
12 Adjustable seat belt anchor p. 2-11
14 13
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
19 10
14. Rear seat* p. 2-07
15. Jack p. 6-07
11 Jack handle p. 6-07
Tools p. 6-07
16. Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - side airbag (for front
seat)* p. 2-35
12
18 17. Front seats p. 2-03
Seat under tray* p. 5-78
17 18. Bottle holder p. 5-79
13 19. Sun visors p. 5-69
16 Card holder p. 5-69
Vanity mirror p. 5-70
15 14
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
13. Floor console box p. 5-76
15 Accessory socket* p. 5-72
Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA)* p. 5-39
14 Auxiliary Video connector (RCA)* p. 5-39
14. Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - curtain airbag* p. 2-35
15. Coat hook* p. 5-80
16. Seat belts p. 2-09
Adjustable seat belt anchor (front seats) p. 2-11
10
13
11
12
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
10 14. Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - side airbag (for front
seat)* p. 2-35
11 15. Front seats p. 2-03
Seat under tray* p. 5-78
16. Sun visors p. 5-69
15 Card holder p. 5-69
Vanity mirror p. 5-70
12
14
13
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
10
4
9
5
6
8
7
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4
10
5
9
6
8
7
OCRE12E1
Overview
10
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4
5
9
8 7
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
11 6
10
7
9 8
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
3
6 5
OCRE12E1
Overview
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Bonnet p. 8-03
13
8
12
9
11
10
OCRE12E1
Overview
9 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
8 3
4
6 5
7
OCRE12E1
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
General information
Fuel selection...................................................................................02
Filling the fuel tank..........................................................................02
Installation of accessories................................................................04
Modification/alterations to the electrical or fuel systems................04
Genuine parts...................................................................................05
Used engine oils safety instructions and disposal infor-
mation..........................................................................................05
Disposal information for used batteries...........................................05
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
General information
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
fuel: “summer” and “winter”. static electricity, fuel vapour could be ig-
This must be considered in winter use. nited.
Select either of the two kinds of fuel in ac- l Do not move away from the fuel tank fill-
cordance with ambient temperature. er until refueling is finished. If you
Above -5 °C: “Summer” diesel moved away and did something else (for
Below -5 °C: “Winter” diesel example, cleaning your windscreen) part-
When travelling abroad, find out in advance way through the refueling process, you
about the fuels served in local service stations. could pick up a fresh charge of static elec-
tricity.
l If the tank cap must be replaced, use only
a MITSUBISHI MOTORS original part.
Refueling
1. Before filling with fuel, stop the engine.
02 OCRE12E1
General information
2. The fuel tank filler is located on the rear left 3. Open the fuel tank filler tube by slowly turn-
side of your vehicle. ing the cap anticlockwise. CAUTION
Type 1
Open the fuel tank filler door with the re- l Since the fuel system may be under pres-
sure, remove the fuel tank filler tube cap
lease lever located below the instrument panel. slowly. This relieves any pressure or vac-
uum that might have built up in the fuel
LHD tank. If you hear a hissing sound, wait un-
til it stops before removing the cap. Oth-
erwise, fuel may spray out, injuring you
or others.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Turn the cap and remove it.
OCRE12E1 03
General information
Installation of accessories Even when such parts are officially authorized, for
example by a “general operators permit” (an ap-
Modification/alterations to the
We recommend you to consult your MITSUBISHI
E00200300875
praisal for the part) or through the execution of the electrical or fuel systems
E00200400238
MOTORS Authorized Service Point. part in an officially approved manner of construc-
MITSUBISHI MOTORS CORPORATION has al-
l The installation of accessories, optional tion, or when a single operation permit following
ways manufactured safe, high quality vehicles. In
parts, should only be carried out within the the attachment or installation of such parts, it can-
order to maintain this safety and quality, it is impor-
limits prescribed by law in your country, and not be deduced from that alone, that the driving safe-
tant that any accessory that is to be fitted, or any
in accordance with the guidelines fitting in- ty of your vehicle has not been affected.
modifications carried out which involve the electri-
structions and warnings contained within the cal or fuel systems, should be carried out in accord-
documents accompanying the parts or acces- Consider also that there basically exists no liability
ance with MITSUBISHI guidelines.
sories. on the part of the appraiser or the official. Only in
l Improper installation of electrical compo- the case of parts (MITSUBISHI MOTORS original
replacement or exchange parts as well as
nents may cause an electrical fire if incorrect-
ly fitted. Please refer to the Modification/al- MITSUBISHI MOTORS genuine accessories) that CAUTION
teration to the electrical or fuel systems sec- are recommended and released by a MITSUBISHI l If the wiring interferes with any part of
tion within this owner’s manual. MOTORS Authorized Service Point and that are at- the vehicle bodywork or improper instal-
l Using a cellular phone or radio set inside the tached or installed by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS lation methods are used, i.e. protective
vehicle without an external antenna may Authorized Service Point can you assume, that op- fuses not installed, etc.), electronic devi-
cause electrical system interference, which timal safety has been provided. The same also per- ces may be adversely affected, possibly re-
could lead to unsafe vehicle operation. tains to modifications of MITSUBISHI vehicle sulting in an electrical fire or other fail-
l Tyres and wheels which do not meet specifi- with respect to the production specifications. For ures that may cause an accident.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
cations must not be used. your own safety, in such cases, you should only un-
Refer to the “Specifications” section for in- dertake modifications according to the recommen-
formation regarding wheel and tyre sizes. dations of a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
l When fitting accessories, ensure that maxi- Service Point.
mum gross vehicle weight and maximum
axle weight are not exceeded.
Important points!
Due to large number of accessory and replacement
parts of different manufactures available in the mar-
ket, it is not possible, not only for MITSUBISHI
MOTORS, but also for a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point, to check whether the at-
tachment or installation of such parts affects the
overall safety of your MITSUBISHI-vehicle.
04 OCRE12E1
General information
Genuine parts Used engine oils safety Disposal information for used
E00200500545
MITSUBISHI MOTORS has gone to great lengths instructions and disposal batteries
to bring you a superbly crafted automobile offering information E00201300029
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ing civic amenity sites and garages providing facili- handling.
ties for disposal of used oil and used oil filters. If in
doubt, contact your local authority for advice on dis-
posal.
OCRE12E1 05
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Locking and unlocking
Keys..............................................................................................1-02
Electronic immobilizer (Anti-theft starting system).....................1-03
Keyless entry system*..................................................................1-04
Doors............................................................................................1-06 1
Central door locks*.......................................................................1-07
“Child-protection” rear doors (Double cab).................................1-08
Manual window control*..............................................................1-08
Electric window control*..............................................................1-08
Quarter window (Club cab)..........................................................1-12
Rear gate.......................................................................................1-13
Sunroof*.......................................................................................1-13
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
Keys WARNING
• Do not leave the key where it may be ex-
posed to high temperature or high humid-
E00300101608
Two keys are provided. The key fits all locks. ity.
l When taking a key on flights, do not
Keep one in a safe place as a spare key. press any switches on the key while on l The engine is designed so that it will not
the plane. If a switch is pressed on the start if the ID code registered in the immobil-
plane, the key emits electromagnetic izer computer and the key’s ID code do not
Type 1
waves, which could adversely affect the match. Refer to the “Electronic immobilizer”
plane’s flight operation. section for details and key usage.
1 When carrying a key in a bag, be careful
that no switches on the key can be easily
pressed by mistake.
NOTE
l The key number is stamped on the tag as in-
dicated in the illustration.
Make a record of the key number and store
the key and key number tag in separate pla-
Type 2 ces, so that you can order a key in the event
the original keys are lost.
l The key is a precision electronic device with
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
a built-in signal transmitter. Please observe
the following in order to prevent a malfunc-
tion.
• Do not leave in a place that is exposed to
direct sunlight, for example on the dash-
board.
• Do not disassemble or modify.
• Do not excessively bend the key or sub-
ject it to strong impacts.
• Do not expose to water.
• Keep away from magnetic key holders.
• Keep away from audio systems, personal
computers, TVs, and other equipment
that generates a magnetic field.
• Do not clean with ultrasonic cleaners or
similar equipment.
1-02 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
other key (Type B)
• When the key contacts or is close to other
immobilizing keys (including keys of oth-
er vehicles) (Type C)
OCRE12E1 1-03
Locking and unlocking
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
To lock function can be changed.
Press the LOCK switch (1), and all doors will be l The keyless entry system does not operate in control switch battery
E00309500190
locked. When they are locked with the room lamp the following conditions: 1. Before replacing the battery, remove static
at the [•] position, the room lamp and the turn-sig- • The key is left in the key cylinder. electricity from your body by touching.
nal lamps blink once. • The door is open.
l The remote control switch will operate with-
To unlock in approximately 4 m from the vehicle. How-
Press the UNLOCK switch (2), and all doors will ever, the operating range of the remote con-
be unlocked. When unlocked with the room lamp trol switch may change if the vehicle is loca-
at the [•] position, the room lamp will be turned on ted near a power station, or radio/TV broad-
for approximately 15 seconds and the turn-signal casting station.
lamps will blink twice. l If either of the following problems occurs,
the battery may be exhausted.
• The remote control switch is operated at
NOTE the correct distance from the vehicle, but
l The indication lamp (3) comes on each time the doors are not locked/unlocked in re-
a switch is pressed. sponse.
1-04 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
2. Remove the screw (A) from the remote con- NOTE 6. Install a new battery with the + side (B) down.
trol switch. l Be sure to perform the procedure with the
MITSUBISHI mark facing you. If the
MITSUBISHI mark is not facing you when
you open the remote control switch case, the + side
switches may come out.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
works.
NOTE
l You may purchase a replacement battery at
5. Remove the old battery. an electric appliance store.
l A MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
ice Point can replace the battery for you if
you prefer.
CAUTION
l When the remote control switch case is
opened, be careful to keep water, dust,
etc. out. Also, do not touch the internal
components.
OCRE12E1 1-05
Locking and unlocking
Doors To lock or unlock from inside the vehi- To lock without using the key
E00300401584 cle
CAUTION
l Make sure the doors are closed: driving
with doors not completely closed is dan-
1 l
gerous.
Never leave children in the vehicle unat-
tended.
l Be careful not to lock the doors while the
key is inside the vehicle.
NOTE
1- Lock Set the inside lock knob (1) to the locked position,
l To prevent the key from being locked inside 2- Unlock and close the door (2).
the vehicle, neither the lock knob on the driv-
er’s door nor the key can be used to lock the
driver’s door when it is open. Pull the inside door handle towards you to open the NOTE
door. l The driver’s door cannot be locked using the
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
To lock or unlock with the key inside lock knob while the driver’s door is
NOTE opened.
l The driver’s door can be opened without us-
ing the lock knob by pulling on the inside
door handle.
If your vehicle is equipped with the central
door lock system, all other doors are un-
locked at the same time.
1-06 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
Central door locks* Driver’s door with inside lock knob NOTE
E00300801504 Set the inside lock knob on the driver’s door to- l The vehicle is shipped from the factory with
wards the front of the vehicle to lock the doors. Set a setting established such that the doors are
NOTE it towards the rear of the vehicle to unlock the doors. not unlocked when the selector lever is
placed in the in the “P” position with the ig-
l Each of the doors can be locked or unlocked nition switch in the “ON” position. If you
independently by using the inside lock knob.
wish to change the setting such that the doors
l Repeated continuous operation between lock are unlocked, contact your MITSUBISHI
and unlock could activate the central door
locking systems built-in protection circuit MOTORS Authorized Service Point. 1
and prevent the system from operating. If
this occurs, wait about 1 minute before oper-
ating the inside lock knob or the key.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Unlocking doors using selector lever
(vehicle with keyless entry system)
It is possible to unlock all of the doors using the se-
lector lever by placing in the “P” position while the
ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
1- Lock
2- Unlock
OCRE12E1 1-07
Locking and unlocking
WARNING
1 l Before operating the electric window con-
trol, make sure that nothing can get trap-
ped (head, hand, finger, etc.).
l Never leave the vehicle without removing
the key.
l Never leave a child (or other person who
might not be capable of safe operation of
1- To open the electric window control) in the vehicle
2- To close alone.
1- Lock
2- Unlock l The child may tamper with the switch at
the risk of its hands or head being trap-
ped in the window.
Child protection helps prevent doors from being
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
opened accidentally, especially when small chil-
dren are in the rear seat. Electric window control switch
E00302301431
A lever is provided on each rear door.
If the lever is set to the locked position, the rear Each window opens or closes while the correspond-
door cannot be opened using the inside handle. ing switch is operated.
To open the rear door while the child protection is
in use, pull the outside door handle. Driver’s switch (LHD)
If the lever is set to the “Unlock” position, the
child protection mechanism does not function.
CAUTION
l When driving with a child in the rear
seat, please use the child protection to pre-
vent accidental door opening which may
cause an accident.
1-08 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
Driver’s switch (RHD) If the switch is fully pressed down/pulled up, the NOTE
door window automatically opens/closes complete- l It is not possible to stop the rear retractable
ly. power window in any position other than the
If you want to stop the window movement, operate fully closed position, ventilation position,
the switch lightly in the reverse direction. and fully open position.
If the rear retractable power window is
NOTE opened while the rear window demister is op-
erating, the rear window demister automati-
l Repeated operation with the engine stopped
will run down the battery. Operate the win- cally stops. When the rear retractable power 1
dow switches only while the engine is running. window is subsequently fully closed, the be-
haviour of the rear window demister depends
l The rear door windows only open halfway.
upon the elapsed time of the rear window de-
1- Driver’s door window
2- Front passenger’s door window mister’s timer. (The timer runs for about 20
Rear retractable power window switch (Double
3- Rear left door window (Double cab) minutes in total.)
cab)*
4- Rear right door window (Double cab) • If the rear window demister’s timer is run-
The rear retractable power window switch can be ning, the rear window demister restarts
5- Lock switch used to operate the rear retractable power window.
6- Rear retractable power window (Double cab)* for the remaining time.
The rear retractable power window stops in three • If the rear window demister’s timer has
positions: the fully closed position, a ventilation po- finished, the rear window demister does
The switches can be used to operate all door win- sition, and the fully open position. not operate. If you wish to activate the
dows. A window can be opened or closed by oper-
rear window demister, press the rear win-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ating the corresponding switch.
dow demister switch again.
Press the switch down to open the window, and
pull up the switch to close it.
1- Close
2- Open
OCRE12E1 1-09
Locking and unlocking
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ing direction of the rear retractable pow- l If the rear retractable power window
er window do not match each other. Exer- switch (1) is lightly pressed while the rear NOTE
cise caution to avoid the risk of accidental- retractable power window is moving
ly trapping a hand or your head when op- from the fully closed position towards the l The driver’s switch can open or close any
door windows.
erating the rear retractable power win- fully open position, the rear retractable
dow. power window will come up to the ventila-
• Even if the rear retractable power win-
dow switch (1) is lightly pressed while
tion position. To avoid the risk of acciden-
tally trapping a hand or your head, do
WARNING
the rear retractable power window is not operate the switch while the rear re- l A child may tamper with the switch at
moving from the fully closed position tractable power window is moving. the risk of its hands or head being trap-
towards the ventilation position, the ped in the window. When driving with a
rear retractable power window does child in the vehicle, please press the win-
not return to the fully closed position.
NOTE dow lock switch to disable the passen-
l The rear retractable power window only ger’s switches and rear retractable power
opens halfway. window switch.
1-10 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
Timer function
E00302400709 WARNING Rear retractable power window
Door’s window If a hand or head is trapped in the closing rear re-
The door windows can be opened or closed for 30 l If the safety mechanism is activated three
tractable power window, it will lower automatically.
or more times successively, the safety
seconds after the ignition switch is turned from the Nonetheless, make sure that nobody puts their head
mechanism will be temporarily cancelled.
“ON” position to the “ACC” or “LOCK” position. or hand out of the rear retractable power window
If a hand or head got trapped, a serious
If the driver’s door is opened during this period, when closing a rear retractable power window.
injury could result.
the door window can be opened or closed for anoth- The lowered window will become operational after
er 30 seconds.
However, once the driver’s door is closed, the win-
a few seconds. 1
dows cannot be operated. CAUTION
Rear retractable power window l The safety mechanism is cancelled just be- WARNING
fore the power window is fully closed.
The rear retractable power window can be opened
This allows the power window to close
l If the safety mechanism is activated three
or closed for 30 seconds after the ignition switch is or more times successively, the safety
completely. Therefore be especially care- mechanism will be temporarily cancelled.
turned from the “ON” position to the “ACC” or
ful that no fingers are trapped in the pow- If a hand or head got trapped, a serious
“LOCK” position.
er window. injury could result.
If the driver’s door is opened during this period,
the rear retractable power window can be opened
or closed for another 30 seconds. NOTE
However, once the driver’s door is closed, the rear l The safety mechanism can be activated if the CAUTION
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
retractable power window cannot be operated. driving conditions or other circumstances
cause the power window to be subjected to a l The safety mechanism is cancelled just be-
Safety mechanism physical shock similar to that caused by a trap-
fore the rear retractable power window is
E00302500537 fully closed. This allows the rear retracta-
Door’s window ped hand or head.
ble power window to close completely.
If a hand or head is trapped in the closing power l If the safety mechanism is activated three or
Therefore be especially careful that no fin-
window, it will lower automatically. more times in a row, the safety mechanism
gers are trapped in the rear retractable
Nonetheless, make sure that nobody puts their head will be cancelled and the power window will
power window.
or hand out of the power window when closing a not close correctly.
power window. In such a case, the following procedure
The lowered window will become operational after should be implemented to rectify this situa- NOTE
tion. Repeatedly raise the appropriate power
a few seconds.
window switch until that power window has
l The safety mechanism can be activated if the
driving conditions or other circumstances
been fully closed. Following this, release the cause the rear retractable power window to
switch, raise the switch once again and hold be subjected to a physical shock similar to
it in this condition for at least one second, that caused by a trapped hand or head.
then release it. You should now be able to op-
erate the power window in the normal fashion.
OCRE12E1 1-11
Locking and unlocking
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
3. Push the lever towards the rear of the vehicle
to secure it in place.
1-12 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
To open
To close The sunroof automatically opens if the switch (3) is
Raise the rear gate and close with enough force to pressed.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
latch the assembly securely into position. To stop the moving sunroof, press the switch (1) or
(2).
NOTE
l The sunroof automatically stops just before
reaching the fully open position.
Press the switch again to fully open it.
To close
The sunroof closes while the switch (2) is pressed.
To tilt up
When the switch (1) is pressed, the rear edge of sun-
roof rises for ventilation.
To tilt down
The sunroof tilt down while the switch (2) is pressed.
OCRE12E1 1-13
Locking and unlocking
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
opening, press the switch (2) to fully close
fully open position.
the sunroof.
If the vehicle is driven with the sunroof in
this position, wind throb is lower than with
NOTE the sunroof fully open.
l The safety mechanism can be activated if the l When leaving the vehicle unattended, make
driving conditions or other circumstances sure you close the sunroof and remove the ig-
cause the sunroof to be subjected to a physi- nition key.
cal shock similar to that caused by a trapped l Do not try to operate the sunroof if it is fro-
hand or head. zen closed (after snow fall or during extreme
l Avoid stopping the sunroof before it reaches CAUTION cold).
the opening or closing end during operations. l Do not sit or place heavy luggage on the sun-
If this should accidentally happen, repeat the l Be careful that hands are not trapped
when closing the sunshade. roof or roof opening edge.
process from step 1. l Release the switch as soon as the sunroof rea-
ches the fully open or fully closed position.
NOTE
l The sunshade will operate together with the
sunroof when the sunroof is opened.
1-14 OCRE12E1
Locking and unlocking
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Operating the sunroof repeatedly with the en-
gine stationary will run down the battery. Op-
erate the sunroof while the engine is running.
OCRE12E1 1-15
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Seat and seat belts
Seat...............................................................................................2-02
Seat adjustment.............................................................................2-03
Front seat......................................................................................2-03
Rear seat*.....................................................................................2-07
Head restraints..............................................................................2-08
Seat belts.......................................................................................2-09
Pregnant women restraint.............................................................2-11
Seat belt pretensioner system and force limiter system*..............2-12
2
Child restraint...............................................................................2-13
Seat belt inspection.......................................................................2-27
Supplemental restraint system (SRS) - airbag*............................2-27
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Seat
E00400101146
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1-Front seat
l To adjust forward or backward ® p. 2-03
l To recline the seatback ® p. 2-04
l To adjust the seat height (Driver’s seat)* ® p. 2-05
l To get in and out of the cargo space (Club cab, passenger’s seat) ® p. 2-05
l Folding the seatback forward (Single cab, passenger’s seat)* ® p. 2-06
l Heated seats* ® p. 2-06
2-Rear seat*
l Folding the seatback forward (Double cab) ® p. 2-07
l Folding up the seat cushion (Club cab)* ® p. 2-07
l Armrest (Double cab) ® p. 2-07
2-02 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
restrained in these areas are more likely
to be seriously injured or killed. driving. The effectiveness of the head re-
Do not allow people or children to ride in straints will be reduced in the event of an
any area of your vehicle that is not equip- accident.
ped with seats and seat belts, and make l When sliding the seats, be careful not to
catch your hand or foot. WARNING
sure that everyone travelling in your vehi-
cle is in a seat and wearing a seat belt, or l When sliding or reclining the seat rear- l To ensure the seat is locked securely, try
in the case of a child is strapped in a child ward, pay careful attention to the rear to move the seat forward or backward
restraint. seat passengers. (Double cab and Club without using the adjusting lever.
cab)
OCRE12E1 2-03
Seat and seat belts
NOTE NOTE
l To prevent the battery from running down, l To prevent the battery from running down,
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
operate the power type seat with the engine operate the power type seat with the engine
running. CAUTION running.
2-04 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Manual type
Adjust the seat height by repeatedly operating the
lever.
1- To move the front of the seat up and down 3- To move the whole seat up and down 2
To get in and out of the cargo space
(Club cab, passenger’s seat)
E00411000021
The lever can be used to make getting in and out
easier.
1- Raise
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
2- Lower
Power type
To adjust the seat height, operate the switch as indi-
cated by arrows.
2- To move the rear of the seat up and down
NOTE
l To prevent the battery from running down,
operate the power type seat with the engine
running.
1- To get in or out
2- To get out
OCRE12E1 2-05
Seat and seat belts
When the lever or pedal is used, the seatback will Pull the band and fold the seatback forward.
tilt forward and at the same time the entire seat will CAUTION
move forward. To return the seat, slide the entire
seat rearward and then raise the seatback rearward l Switch off seat heaters when not in use.
to lock the seat in position. l Operate in the high position for quick heat-
ing. Once the seat is warm, set the heater
to low to keep it warm. Slight variations
WARNING in seat temperature may be felt while us-
ing the heated seats. This is caused by the
l Do not drive the vehicle with the seatback operation of the heater’s internal thermo-
folded forward. The seat is not retained stat and does not indicate a malfunction.
position if it is not kept in an upright posi- l If the following types of persons use the
2 tion, so serious injuries could be suffered
in the event of hard braking or a collision.
heated seats, they might become too hot
or receive minor burns (red skin, heat blis-
ters, etc.):
• Children, elderly or ill people
Heated seats*
CAUTION E00401100784
• People with sensitive skin
• Excessively tired people
The heated seats can be operated with the ignition
l The reclining mechanism of the seatback switch in the “ON” position. • People under the influence of alcohol
is spring loaded, causing it to return to or sleep inducing medication (cold
the vertical position when the lock lever medicine, etc.)
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
is operated. When using the lever, sit l Do not place heavy objects on the seat or
close to the seatback or hold it with your stick pins, needles, or other pointed ob-
hand. jects into it.
l Use a foot to operate the pedal (2). l Do not use a blanket, cushion, or other ma-
terial with high heat insulation properties
on the seat while using the heater; this
Folding the seatback forward (Single might cause the heater element to overheat
cab, passenger’s seat)* l When cleaning the seat, do not use ben-
E00410400031 zene, kerosene, petrol, alcohol, or other or-
To access the onboard tool kit, fold forward the seat- ganic solvents; these might damage the
back of the passenger’s seat. surface of the seat and also the heater ele-
Refer to “Tools, jack and jack handle” on page ment.
6-07. l If water or any other liquid is spilled on
1 (HI)- Heater high (for quick heating).
the seat, allow it to dry thoroughly before
2- Heater off. attempting to use the heater.
3 (LO)- Heater low (to keep the seat warm). l Turn the heater off immediately if it ap-
pears to be malfunctioning during use.
The indication lamp (A) will illuminate while the
heater is on.
2-06 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Rear seat* Securely retain the seat cushion by hooking the re-
taining band (A) onto the head restraint (B) of the
NOTE
E00401300148 l Do not stand or sit on the armrest. It could
When a person is sitting in the middle seating posi- rear seat. break.
tion of the rear seat, adjust the head restraint to l The top surface of the armrest contains a cup
height at which it lock in position. Refer to “Head holder for rear seat occupants.
restraints” on page 2-08. Refer to “Cup holder” on page 5-78.
Folding the seatback forward (Double
cab)
E00401600242
Pull up the band on the top of the seatback and fold
it forward.
2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
(into the seatback) until it is level with the seat.
OCRE12E1 2-07
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
of the restraint is as close as possible to eye level to knob (A) pushed in.
reduce the chances of injury in the event of colli- l Confirm that the height adjusting knob
(A) is correctly adjusted as shown in the
sion. Any person too tall for the restraint to reach illustration, and also lift the head re-
their seated eye level, should adjust the restraint as straints to ensure that they do not come
high as possible. out of the seatback.
2-08 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
WARNING
your lap when riding in this vehicle, even
if you are wearing your seat belt. To do 2
CAUTION l Always place the shoulder belt over your
so risks severe or fatal injury to the child
in a collision or sudden stop.
shoulder and across your chest. Never
l If your vehicle is equipped with the rear
put it behind you or under your arm. l Always adjust the seat belt to a snug fit.
seat head restraint, the head restraints
for the front and rear seats differ in size. l One seat belt should be used by only one
When installing head restraints, make person. Doing otherwise can be dangerous.
sure the front and rear head restraints l The seat belt will provide its wearer with
are fitted in their respective seats. maximum protection if the recliner seat-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
back is placed in fully upright position.
When the seatback is reclined, there is
greater risk that the passenger will slide
under the belt, especially in a forward im-
pact accident, and may be injured by the
belt or by striking the instrument panel
or seatbacks.
l Seat belts should always be worn by ev-
ery adult who drives or rides in this vehi-
cle, and by all children who are tall
enough to wear seat belts properly. 3-point type seat belt (with emergency
l Remove any twists when using the belt.
locking mechanism)
l No modifications or additions should be E00404901126
made by the user which will either pre- This type of belt requires no length adjustment.
vent the seat belt adjusting devices from Once worn, the belt adjusts itself to the movement
operating to remove slack, or prevent the of the wearer, but in the event of a sudden or strong
seat belt assembly from being adjusted to shock, the belt automatically locks to hold the wear-
remove slack. er’s body.
OCRE12E1 2-09
Seat and seat belts
NOTE NOTE
l You can check if the belt locks by pulling it WARNING l For the front passenger seat, the warning func-
forward quickly. l The seat belts must not be twisted when tion works only while a person is sitting on
worn. the seat.
To fasten
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly while holding
the latch plate. 3. Pull the belt slightly to adjust slackness as de-
sired.
NOTE To unfasten
l When the seat belts cannot be pulled out in a Hold the latch plate and push the button on the buck-
locked condition, pull the belts once forceful-
le.
2 ly and then return them. After that, pull the
belts out slowly once again.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
remains unfastened approximately 1 minute later,
the warning lamp will flash and the tone sound in-
termittently (each 12 times) when the vehicle is driv-
en. If the passenger subsequently unfastens the seat
belt while driving, the warning lamp and tone will
NOTE issue further warnings. And if the seat belt remains
l As the belt retracts automatically, keep hold- unfastened, the warning lamp and tone will issue
ing the latch plate while retracting so that the further warnings each time the vehicle starts mov-
belt stows slowly. Failure to do this could ing from a stop. When the seat belt is fastened, the
damage the vehicle. warnings will stop.
WARNING
l Never wear the lap portion of the belt Seat belt reminder/warning lamp
E00409800790
across your abdomen. During accidents it A tone and warning lamp are used to remind the
can press sharply against the abdomen driver and front passenger to fasten the seat belt.
and increase the risk of injury.
2-10 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
l In order to reduce the risk of serious or fa- l When adjusting the seat belt anchor, set
tal injury in an accident, always wear it at a position that is sufficiently high so
your own seat belt. Do not allow anyone that the belt will make full contact with WARNING
to ride in your vehicle unless he or she is your shoulder but will not touch your neck.
also seated and wearing a seat belt. Chil- l Seat belts work for everyone, including
pregnant women. Pregnant women
dren should additionally be restrained in should use the available seat belts. This
a secure child restraint system. Lap belts*
E00405100128 will reduce the likelihood of injury to
The lap belts should be adjusted by holding the belt both the woman and the unborn child.
NOTE and latch plate at right angles to each other, and The lap belt should be worn across the
l When luggage is placed on the front passen- then pulling the belt as shown in the illustration to thighs and as snug against the hips as pos-
sible, but not across the waist. Consult
2
ger seat, a sensor in the seat cushion may, de- a snug fit around the occupant.
pending on the weight and position of the lug- your doctor if you have any additional
gage, cause the warning tone to sound and questions or concerns.
the warning lamp to come on (Double cab).
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
E00405000299
The seat belt anchor height can be adjusted.
Move the seat belt anchor down with the lock knob
(A) depressed. To move the anchor up, slide it with-
out depressing the lock knob (A).
OCRE12E1 2-11
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
pretensioner seat belts could cause inju-
ries.
NOTE
l The pretensioner seat belts will be activated
if the vehicle suffers a severe frontal impact,
even if the seat belts are not worn.
1- Front impact sensors
2- Seat belt pretensioners
l The pretensioner seat belts are designed to
work only once. After the pretensioner seat
3- Airbag control unit belts have been activated, we recommend
you have them replaced by a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
2-12 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
WARNING 2
NOTE
l When possible, put children in the rear l If you have a rearward facing child restraint
seat. Accident statistics indicate that chil- system that cannot be fitted to any seat other
dren of all sizes and ages are safer when than the front passenger seat, be sure to turn
properly restrained in the rear seat rath- OFF the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
er than in the front seat. (Double cab and switch before using it. (Refer to “To turn an
Club cab) airbag off” on page 2-30.)
l Holding a child in your arms is no substi-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
tute for a restraint system. Failure to use
a proper restraint system can result in se-
vere or fatal injury to the child. Front passenger’s airbag OFF
l Each child restraint device or fixing is to
be used only by one child.
l When attaching a child restraint to the
rear seat, place the front seatbacks in the WARNING
upright position.
Otherwise, the child could be seriously in-
l Extreme Hazard!
Do not use a rearward facing child re-
jured in the event of hard braking or a col- straint on a seat protected by an airbag in
lision. (Double cab and Club cab) front of it!
l A REARWARD FACING CHILD RE-
STRAINT must NOT be used in the front
passenger seat if the front passenger’s air-
bag has not been deactivated. The force
of an inflating airbag could kill or cause
serious injuries to the child.
OCRE12E1 2-13
Seat and seat belts
Instruction:
WARNING l For small infants, an infant carrier should be WARNING
used. For small children whose height when
l A FORWARD FACING CHILD RE-
seated allows the shoulder belt to lie in con-
l When the child restraint system is not in
STRAINT should not be used in the front use, keep your child restraint system se-
passenger seat whenever possible; if used tact with the face or the throat, a child seat cured with the seat belt or remove it from
in the front passenger seat, adjust the should be used. the vehicle in order to prevent it from be-
seat to the most rearward position. l The child restraint system should be appropri- ing thrown around inside the vehicle dur-
ate for the child’s weight and height and prop- ing an accident.
erly fit in the vehicle.
l Before purchasing a child restraint system,
try installing it in the seat to make sure there NOTE
is a good fit. Because of the location of the l Depending on the seating position in the ve-
2 seat belt buckles and the shape of the seat hicle and the child restraint system that you
cushion, it may be difficult to securely install have, the child restraint can be attached us-
some manufacturer’s child restraint systems. ing one of the following two locations:
If the child restraint system can be pulled for- • To the lower anchorage in the rear seat
ward or to either side easily on the seat cush- ONLY if the child restraint has ISOFIX
ion after the seat belt has been tightened, mountings (Double cab, See page 2-25).
choose another manufacturer’s child restraint • To the seat belt (See page 2-26).
system.
Older children
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
WARNING
E00406700235
Infants and small children Children who have outgrown the child restraint sys-
E00406600768
When transporting infants and small children in tem should be seated in the rear seat and wear com-
l When installing a child restraint system, bination lap shoulder belt.
your vehicle, follow the instruction given below. refer to the instructions provided by the
manufacturer of the restraint system. Fail- The lap portion of the belt should be snug and posi-
ure to do so can result in severe or fatal tioned low on the abdomen so that it is below the
injury to the child. top of the hip-bone. Otherwise, the belt could in-
trude into the child’s abdomen during an accident
l After installation, push and pull the child
and cause injury.
restraint system back and forth, and side
to side, to see that it is properly secured.
If the child restraint system is not instal-
led securely, it may cause injury to the WARNING
child or other occupants in the case of ac- l Children who are not buckled up can be
cident or sudden stops. thrown out of the vehicle in an accident.
2-14 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
WARNING
l Children who are not buckled up can
strike other people in the vehicle in an ac-
cident.
l A child should never be left unattended
in your vehicle. When you leave the vehi-
cle, take the child with you.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1 2-15
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
A ISO/F3 IUF
II -15 to 25 kg X
III -22 to 36 kg X
CAUTION
l When installing a child restraint system, prevent the head restraint from touching the child restraint system by removing it or adjusting its height.
2-16 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
NOTE
2
l MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to changes without any prior announcement.
For further information, please contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1 2-17
Seat and seat belts
Seating position
Mass group Front passenger
Activated airbag Deactivated airbag#1
0 - Up to 10 kg X X
0+ - Up to 13 kg X L*1, L*2
2 I -9 to 18 kg X L*3, L*4
II -15 to 25 kg X L*5
III -22 to 36 kg X L*5
#1: With front passenger’s airbag deactivated by means of front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch.
CAUTION
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l When installing a child restraint system, prevent the head restraint from touching the child restraint system by removing it or adjusting its height.
2-18 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Seating position
Mass group Front passenger
Front centre
Activated airbag Deactivated airbag#1
0 - Up to 10 kg X X X
0+ - Up to 13 kg X L*1, L*2 X
I -9 to 18 kg X L*3, L*4 X
II -15 to 25 kg X L*5 X
III -22 to 36 kg X L*5 X
#1: With front passenger’s airbag deactivated by means of front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch.
OCRE12E1 2-19
Seat and seat belts
CAUTION
l When installing a child restraint system, prevent the head restraint from touching the child restraint system by removing it or adjusting its height.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
#2: To be available in 2012
NOTE
l There is no applicable MITSUBISHI MOTORS Genuine Parts to the Mass Group “0-Up to 10 kg”.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to changes without any prior announcement.
For further information, please contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
2-20 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Club cab
Seating position
Mass group Front passenger
Rear outboard
Activated airbag Deactivated airbag#1
0 - Up to 10 kg X X X
0+ - Up to 13 kg X L*1, L*2 L*1, L*2
I -9 to 18 kg X L*3, L*4 L*3, L*4
II -15 to 25 kg X L*5 X
2
III -22 to 36 kg X L*5 X
#1: With front passenger’s airbag deactivated by means of front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch.
CAUTION
l When installing a child restraint system, prevent the head restraint from touching the child restraint system by removing it or adjusting its height.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Key of letters to be inserted in the table above:
l L- Suitable for particular child restraints in the following list (MITSUBISHI MOTORS genuine parts).
l X- Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
OCRE12E1 2-21
Seat and seat belts
NOTE
l There is no applicable MITSUBISHI MOTORS Genuine Parts to the Mass Group “0-Up to 10 kg”.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Europe B.V. reserves the right to changes without any prior announcement.
For further information, please contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
Double cab
Seating position
Mass group Front passenger
Rear outboard Rear centre
2 Activated airbag Deactivated airbag#1
0 - Up to 10 kg X X U X
0+ - Up to 13 kg X L*1, L*2 U, L*1, L*2 X
I -9 to 18 kg X L*3, L*4 U, L*3, L*4 L*3
II -15 to 25 kg X L*5 U, L*5 L*5
III -22 to 36 kg X L*5 U, L*5 L*5
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
#1: With front passenger’s airbag deactivated by means of front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch.
CAUTION
l When installing a child restraint system, prevent the head restraint from touching the child restraint system by removing it or adjusting its height.
2-22 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1 2-23
Seat and seat belts
Child restraint anchorage points (Dou- Tether anchorage strap installation 3. Tip the armrest forward. Open the fastener
ble cab)* (B) that is located in the space where the arm-
E00406900354 rest was stowed.
WARNING
Anchorage locations
There are 2 child restraint anchorage points on the l Child restraint anchorages are designed
floor, located behind the rear seat. These are for se- to withstand only those loads imposed by
curing a child restraint system tether strap to each correctly fitted child restraints. Under no
of the 2 rear seating positions in your vehicle. circumstances are they to be used for
adult seat belts, harnesses, or for attach-
ing other items or equipment to the vehicle.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
*: Rear of the vehicle
CAUTION
l The anchorages are only applicable for
child restraints fitted in the rear seat.
2-24 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Installing a child restraint system to It is not necessary to retain the child restraint sys- 1. Push the child restraint system’s connectors
the lower anchorage (ISOFIX child re- tem using the vehicle’s seat belts. into the lower anchorages (A) in accordance
with the instructions provided by the child re-
straint mountings)* straint system’s manufacturer.
E00408900114
Your vehicle’s second seat is fitted with lower an-
chorages for attaching a child restraint system with
ISOFIX mountings.
2
A- Child restraint system connectors
To install
If your child restraint system requires the use
of a tether strap, fasten the tether strap in ac-
WARNING cordance with the following procedures.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Child restraint system with ISOFIX l If there is any foreign material in or
around the connectors, remove it before 2. Remove the head restraint from the location
mountings in which you wish to install a child restraint.
E00409000369 installing the child restraint system. Also,
The child restraint system is designed only for make sure the seat belt is away from, not 3. Drop the child restraint’s tether strap (B)
seats that incorporate lower anchorages. Retain the looped through or otherwise interfering down the back of the rear seatback.
child restraint system using the lower anchorages. with, the child restraint system. If foreign
matter is not removed and/or the seat
belt interferes with the child restraint sys-
tem, the child restraint system will not be
secured properly and could move for-
ward in the event of sudden braking or a
collision, seriously injuring the child and
possibly other vehicle occupants.
l When the vehicle is moving do not adjust
the seat where the child restraint system
is installed.
OCRE12E1 2-25
Seat and seat belts
5. Put your hand in the opening of the fastener, Front passenger seat
attach the tether strap’s hook (D) to the teth-
er anchorage (E), and securely tighten the teth- Double cab
er strap.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Front passenger seat
Installation:
1. Fasten the seat belt to secure the child re-
straint system.
Make sure you hear a “click” when you in-
sert the latch plate in the buckle.
2. Remove all slack by using the locking clip.
3. Push and pull the child restraint in all direc-
6. Push and pull the child restraint system in all tions to be sure it is secure.
directions to be sure it is firmly secured.
2-26 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
l Check the belts for cuts, worn or frayed web- (SRS) - airbag* • Seat belts help keep the driver and pas-
E00407201797
bing and for cracked or deformed metallic sengers properly positioned, which re-
The information written in this Supplemental Re-
parts. Replace the belt assembly if defective. duces injury risk in all collisions, and
straint System (SRS) section contains important
l A dirty belt should be cleaned with neutral de-
points concerning the driver, front passenger, side reduces the risk of serious or fatal in-
tergent in warm water. After rinsing in water, juries when the airbags inflate.
and curtain airbags.
let it dry in the shade. Do not attempt to During sudden braking just before a
The SRS driver and front passenger airbags are de-
bleach or re-dye the belts because this affects collision, an unrestrained or improper-
signed to supplement the primary protection of the
their characteristics. ly restrained driver or passengers can
driver and front passenger side seat belt systems by
providing those occupants with protection against move forward into direct contact with
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
erate properly. ment the properly worn seat belts and provide the
driver and passengers with protection against head cause driver’s and passenger’s air-
l Do not attempt to repair or replace any
bags are not designed to inflate in
part of the seat belt assemblies; we recom- injuries in certain moderate-to-severe side impact
mend you to have this work done by a collisions. those situations.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized • Seat belts reduce the risk of being
Service Point. Incorrect repair or replace- The SRS is NOT a substitute for the seat belts; for thrown from your vehicle in a colli-
ment could reduce the effectiveness of the maximum protection in all types of crashes and ac- sion or roll-over.
belts and could result in serious injury in cidents, seat belts should ALWAYS be worn by ev- l IT IS VERY IMPORTANT TO BE PROP-
the event of a collision. eryone who drives or rides in this vehicle. ERLY SEATED.
A driver or front passenger too close to
l Once the pretensioner has activated, it
the steering wheel or instrument panel
cannot be re-used.
It must be replaced together with the re- WARNING during airbag deployment can be killed
or seriously injured.
tractor.
l IT IS VERY IMPORTANT TO AL- Airbags inflate very fast, and with great
WAYS PROPERLY WEAR YOUR force.
SEAT BELT, EVEN WITH AN AIRBAG: If the driver and front passenger are not
properly seated and restrained, the air-
OCRE12E1 2-27
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Do not put feet or legs on or against the
instrument panel. Front passenger’s airbag OFF
WARNING
l A REARWARD FACING CHILD RE-
STRAINT must NOT be used in the front
passenger seat if the front passenger’s air-
bag has not been deactivated. The force
of an inflating airbag could kill or cause
serious injuries to the child.
2-28 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
Caution for installing the child re- How the Supplemental Restraint Sys-
WARNING straint on vehicles with a front passen- tem works
lA FORWARD FACING CHILD RE- ger airbag E00407301352
The SRS includes the following components:
STRAINT should not be used in the front E00408800272
passenger seat whenever possible; if used The label shown here is attached on vehicles with a
in the front passenger seat, adjust the front passenger airbag.
seat to the most rearward position. Fail-
ure to do so could kill or cause serious in-
juries to the child.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5- Airbag control unit
6- Front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch
WARNING
l Older children should be seated, properly
wearing the seat belt, with an appropri-
WARNING
ate booster seat if needed. l Extreme Hazard!
Do not use a rearward facing child re-
straint on a seat protected by an airbag in
front of it!
OCRE12E1 2-29
Seat and seat belts
The airbags will operate only when the ignition The front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch is lo-
switch is in the “ON” or “START” position. cated in the glove box. WARNING
When the airbag control unit detect an impact of suf- • Always remove the key from the front
ficient frontal or side force, it sends an ignition sig- passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch af-
nal to the airbag modules to ignite materials in the ter operating that switch. Failure to
inflator and generate gas and inflate the airbags. do so could lead to improper position
The airbags deployment produces a sudden, loud of the front passenger’s airbag ON-
noise, and releases some smoke and powder, but OFF switch.
these conditions are not injurious, and do not indi-
cate a fire in the vehicle. People with respiratory
problems may feel some temporary irritation from To turn an airbag off
chemicals used to produce the deployment; open E00410600219
2 the windows after airbag deployment, if safe to do To turn an airbag off, follow these steps:
1. Insert the key into the key opening of the ap-
so.
The airbags deflate very rapidly after deployment, propriate front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
so there is little danger of obscured vision. switch, and turn that airbag ON-OFF switch
The time required from the sensors detecting an im- to the “OFF” position.
pact to deflation of the airbags after deployment is WARNING 2. Remove the key from the key opening of the
front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch.
shorter than a blink of an eye.
l To reduce risk of serious or fatal injury: 3. Insert the key into the ignition switch, and
• Always remove the key from the igni- turn the ignition to the “ON” position.
tion switch before operating a front
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
CAUTION passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch.
Failure to do so could adversely affect
l Airbags inflate at an extremely rapid
the airbag performance.
speed. In certain situations, contact with
inflating airbags can result in abrasions, • Wait at least 60 seconds to operate the
light cuts, bruises, and the like. front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF
switch after turning the ignition
switch from “ON” position to
Front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF “LOCK” position.
switch The SRS airbag system is designed to
E00410100184 retain enough voltage to deploy the air-
The front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch can bag.
be used to disable the front passenger’s airbag. If
you have a rearward facing child restraint system
that cannot be fitted to any seat other than the front The front passenger’s airbag OFF indication lamp
passenger seat, be sure to turn OFF the front passen- will stay on to show that the front passenger’s air-
ger’s airbag ON-OFF switch before using it. (Refer bag is not operational. (“Front passenger’s airbag
to “To turn an airbag off” on page 2-30.) OFF indication lamp” on page 2-31)
2-30 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
That airbag will remain OFF, and will NOT de- 3. Insert the key into the ignition switch, and Front passenger’s airbag OFF indica-
ploy, until it is turned ON again. turn the ignition to the “ON” position. tion lamp
E00410200257
The front passenger’s airbag OFF indication lamp
WARNING is located in the instrument panel.
l To reduce risk of serious or fatal injury:
• If the indication lamp does not come
on when the front passenger’s airbag
ON-OFF switch is turned OFF, do not
fit a rearward facing child restraint
system to the front passenger seat.
• Do not turn OFF the front passen-
ger’s airbag ON-OFF switch except
2
when a rearward facing child re-
straint system is fitted to the front pas-
senger seat. The front passenger’s airbag OFF indication lamp
goes off to show that the front passenger’s airbag is
To turn an airbag on operational.
E00410700106 When the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch
To turn an airbag on, follow these steps: That airbag will remain ON, and will be ready to is turned OFF, the indication lamp will stay on to
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. Insert the key into the key opening of the ap- deploy, until it is again turned OFF. show that the front passenger’s airbag is not opera-
propriate front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF tional.
switch, and turn that airbag ON-OFF switch When the front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch
to “ON” position.
2. Remove the key from the key opening of that
WARNING is turned ON, the indication lamp goes off to show
that the front passenger’s airbag is operational.
front passenger’s airbag ON-OFF switch. l To reduce risk of serious or fatal injury:
• Turn ON the front passenger’s airbag
ON-OFF switch immediately after re-
moving a rearward facing child re- WARNING
straint system from the front passen- l If the indication lamp behaves in any of
ger seat. the following ways, there may be a fault
• If the indication lamp remains on in the airbag system.
when the front passenger’s airbag Have the vehicle inspected at a
ON-OFF switch is turned ON, do not MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
allow anyone to sit on the front passen- Service Point as soon as possible.
ger seat.
OCRE12E1 2-31
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Head-on collision with a solid wall at speed of Moderate to severe frontal impact within the shaded
approximately 25 km/h (16 mph) or higher area between the arrows
2-32 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
The front airbags are designed to deploy when the The front airbags MAY NOT DEPLOY when… Because the front airbags do not protect the occu-
vehicle suffers a moderate to severe frontal impact. With certain types of frontal collisions, the vehi- pant in all types of frontal collisions, be sure to al-
A typical condition is shown in the illustration. cle’s body structure is designed to absorb the shock ways properly wear your seat belts.
to help protect the occupants from harm. (The vehi-
The front airbags will deploy if the severity of im- cle body’s front area may deform significantly as it Collision with a utility pole, tree or other narrow objects
pact is above the designed threshold level, compa- absorbs the impact.) Under such circumstances, the
rable to an approximately 25 km/h (16 mph) colli- front airbags may not deploy irrespective of the de-
sion when impacting straight into a solid wall that formation and damage to the vehicle body. Exam-
does not move or deform. If the severity of the im- ples of some typical conditions are shown in the il-
pact is below the above threshold level, the front air- lustration.
bags may not deploy. However, this threshold Examples of some typical conditions are shown in
speed will be considerably higher if the vehicle the illustration.
strikes an object that absorbs the impact by either 2
deforming or moving (for example, another station- Vehicle slides under the rear body of a truck
ary vehicle, pole or a guard rail).
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ployment. The initial stage of airbag inflation is the Oblique frontal impacts
most forceful, and can possibly cause serious or fa-
tal injuries. Moreover, the seat belts in your vehicle
are your primary means of protection in a collision.
The SRS airbags are designed to provide additional
protection. Therefore, for your safety and the safe-
ty of all occupants, be sure to always properly wear
your seat belts.
OCRE12E1 2-33
Seat and seat belts
Because the front airbags do not protect the occu- Because the front airbags may deploy in certain
pant in all types of collisions, be sure to always prop- types of unexpected impacts as shown in the illus- WARNING
erly wear your seat belts. tration that can easily move you out of position, it
is important to always properly wear your seat l Do not attach anything to the steering
wheel padded cover, such as trim materi-
belts. Your seat belts will help keep you a safe dis- al, badges, etc. It might strike and injure
Rear end collisions
tance from the steering wheel and instrument panel an occupant if the airbag inflates.
during the initial stages of airbag deployment. The
initial stage of airbag inflation is the most forceful l Do not set anything on, or attach any-
thing to, the instrument panel above the
and can possibly cause serious or fatal injuries if glove box. It might strike and injure an oc-
you contact it at this stage. cupant if the airbag inflates.
2 Side collisions
Collision with an elevated median/island or kerb
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Vehicle travels over a deep hole/pothole
Vehicle rolls onto its side or roof
WARNING
l Do not attach accessories to, or put them
Vehicle drives down a steep slope and hits the ground in front of, the windscreen. These objects
could restrict the airbag inflation, or
strike and injure an occupant if the air-
The front airbags MAY DEPLOY when… bags inflate.
The front airbags may deploy if the bottom of the l Do not put packages, pets or other ob-
vehicle suffers a moderate-to-severe impact (under- jects between the airbags and the driver
carriage damage). or front passenger. It could affect airbag
Examples of some typical conditions are shown in performance, or could cause injury when
the illustration. the airbag inflates.
2-34 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
The label shown here is attached to the seatbacks Deployment of side airbags and cur-
WARNING with a side airbag. tain airbags
l Right after the airbag inflation, several E00407701011
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
is impacted, even with no passenger in the front
seat or rear seat.
OCRE12E1 2-35
Seat and seat belts
The side airbags and curtain airbags MAY NOT Because the side airbags and curtain airbags do not Oblique side impacts
DEPLOY when… protect the occupant in all types of side collisions,
With certain types of side collisions, the vehicle’s be sure to always properly wear your seat belts.
body structure is designed to absorb the shock to
help protect the occupants from harm. (The vehicle Side impacts in an area away from the passenger
body’s side area may deform significantly as it ab- compartment
sorbs the impact.) Under such circumstances, the
side airbags and curtain airbags may not deploy ir-
respective of the deformation and damage to the ve-
hicle body.
Examples of some typical conditions are shown in Vehicle rolls onto its side
2 the illustration. or roof
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Collision with a utility pole, tree or other narrow object
2-36 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
2
WARNING
l Do not allow any rear seat occupant to
hold onto the seatback of either front
seat, in order to reduce risk of injury
Rear end collisions from the deploying side airbag. Special
care should be taken with children.
l Do not place any objects near or in front
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
of the seatback of either front seat. They
could interfere with proper side airbag in-
flation, and also could cause injury if
thrown free by side airbag deployment.
Because the side airbags and curtain airbags do not WARNING l Do not place stickers, labels or additional
trim on the seatback of either front seat.
protect the occupant in all types of collisions, be
sure to always properly wear your seat belts. l Do not allow a child to kneel on the pas- They could interfere with proper side air-
senger seat facing the passenger’s side bag inflation.
door, since the side airbags and curtain l Do not install seat covers on seats with
WARNING airbags inflate with great force.
Otherwise, the child may be killed or seri-
side airbags. Do not re-cover seats that
have side airbags. This could interfere
l The side airbags and curtain airbags are ously injured. with proper side airbag inflation.
designed to supplement the driver and pas-
senger seat belts in certain side impacts.
Seat belts should always be worn proper-
ly, and the driver and passenger should
sit well back and upright without leaning
against the window or door.
OCRE12E1 2-37
Seat and seat belts
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Failure to follow all of these instructions
could lead to serious or fatal injury to the
child.
l We recommend work around and on the
side airbags and curtain airbags system
to be done by MITSUBISHI MOTORS
Authorized Service Point. Improper
work could result in inadvertent deploy-
ment of a side airbags and curtain air-
WARNING
bags, or could render a side airbags and l If any of the following conditions occur,
curtain airbags inoperative; either situa- the SRS and/or seat belt pretensioners
tion could result in serious injury. are not working properly, and we recom-
mend you to have it inspected by a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
Service Point immediately.
2-38 OCRE12E1
Seat and seat belts
WARNING WARNING
• The SRS warning lamp does not illu- l On vehicles equipped with side airbags,
minate when you start the vehicle. do not modify your front seats, centre pil-
• The SRS warning lamp does not go lar and centre console.
out after several seconds. It can adversely affect SRS performance
• The SRS warning lamp illuminates and lead to possible injury.
while driving. Also, if you have found any tear or open
seam in the seat fabric at the portion near
the side airbag, we recommend you to
SRS servicing have the seat inspected.
2
E00407901244
l On vehicles with the curtain airbags, if
you have found any scratch, crack or dam-
age to the portion of the front and rear pil-
WARNING lars and roof side rail, we recommend
l We recommend any maintenance per- you to have the SRS inspected by a
formed on or near the components of the MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
SRS to be performed by a MITSUBISHI Service Point.
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
Improper work on the SRS components
or wiring could result in inadvertent de- NOTE
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ployment of the airbags, or could render l When you transfer ownership of the vehicle
the SRS inoperative; either situation to some other person, we urge you to alert
could result in serious injury. the new owner that it is equipped with the
SRS and refer the new owner to the applica-
l Do not modify your steering wheel, seat
ble section in this owner’s manual.
belt retractor or any other SRS compo-
nents. For example, replacement of the l If you junk or scrap the vehicle, we urge you
steering wheel, or modifications to the to first take the vehicle to a MITSUBISHI
front bumper or body structure can ad- MOTORS Authorized Service Point so that
versely affect SRS performance and lead the SRS can be rendered safe.
to possible injury.
l If your vehicle has sustained any damage,
we recommend you to have the SRS in-
spected to ensure it is in proper working
order.
OCRE12E1 2-39
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Instruments and controls
Instruments...................................................................................3-02
Indication and warning lamps.......................................................3-06
Indication lamps...........................................................................3-07
Warning lamps..............................................................................3-08
Centre information display*.........................................................3-10
Combination headlamps and dipper switch..................................3-30
Headlamp levelling switch*.........................................................3-32
Turn-signals lever.........................................................................3-33
Hazard warning flasher switch.....................................................3-34
Front fog lamp switch*.................................................................3-34
Rear fog lamp switch*..................................................................3-35 3
Wiper and washer switch..............................................................3-36
Rear window demister switch.......................................................3-40
Horn switch...................................................................................3-40
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Instruments
E00500100876
Type A Type B
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- Tachometer 4- Odometer/Tripmeter
2- Speedometer 5- Tripmeter reset button/Daytime dipper button*
3- Fuel gauge 6- Water temperature gauge
3-02 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
3
A- Odometer
B- Tripmeter
C- Reset button
Indication for km/h and mph
CAUTION
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The speedometer indicates the vehicle’s speed in Odometer
miles per hour (mph) and kilometers per hour The odometer indicates the total distance the vehi-
(km/h). l When driving, watch the tachometer to cle has travelled.
make sure that the engine speed indica-
tion does not rise into the red zone (exces- Tripmeter
sive engine rpm). The tripmeter indicates the distance travelled dur-
ing a particular trip or period.
There are two tripmeter displays: TRIP and
.
TRIP can be used to measure the distance trav-
elled since the current trip began. At the same time,
TRIP can be used to measure the distance from
an intermediate location.
OCRE12E1 3-03
Instruments and controls
Every time the reset button (C) is pressed lightly NOTE Fuel lid mark
(less than 1 second), the tripmeter display changes l Display TRIP and each have a maxi- The fuel lid mark (A) indicates that the fuel tank fill-
(between TRIP and ). mum distance of 999.9 km (999.9 miles). er door is located on the left side of the vehicle (Re-
l When disconnecting the battery terminal for fer to “Filling the fuel tank” on page 02).
Type 1 a long time, the memory of tripmeter display Low fuel warning lamp
TRIP and are cleared, and the dis- E00508100739
play returns to “0”. The warning lamp (A) comes on when the fuel lev-
el is getting low (approx. 11 litres) with the igni-
Fuel gauge tion switch in the “ON” position. Refuel as soon as
E00500700902 possible.
The fuel gauge indicates the fuel level in the fuel
tank when the ignition switch is in the “ON” position.
3
Type 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE
F- Full
E- Empty
l On inclines or curves, due to the movement
of fuel in the tank, the low fuel warning lamp
may indicate incorrectly.
NOTE
To reset the tripmeter
To return the display to “0”, press the reset button l When the engine on diesel-powered vehicles
fails to operate due to running out of fuel, it
(C) for more than 1 second. Only the currently dis-
may sometimes be difficult to start after refu-
played value will be reset. If TRIP is dis- eling. This is due to air entering the fuel sys-
played, for example, only TRIP will be reset. tem. Therefore, air must be bled from the sys-
tem. (Refer to “Bleeding the fuel system” on
page 6-05.)
3-04 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Water temperature gauge Turn the dial to adjust the illumination (meter, mul-
E00500800479 ti centre display, audio system’s control panel, heat-
The water temperature gauge indicates the engine er control panel, etc.) to the desired brightness.
coolant temperature when the ignition switch is in
the “ON” position.
1- To reduce brightness 3
2- To increase brightness
CAUTION
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l If the indication needle enters the H zone
while the engine is running, it indicates
that the engine is possibly overheating. Im-
mediately park your vehicle in a safe
place and make the necessary correc-
tions. (Refer to “Engine overheating” on
page 6-04.)
While driving, care should always be tak-
en to maintain the normal operating tem-
perature.
OCRE12E1 3-05
Instruments and controls
Type 1 Type 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. CRUISE indication lamp* ® p. 4-50 13. Fuel filter indication lamp ® p. 3-07
2. Turn-signal indication lamps/Hazard warning indication lamps ® p. 3-07 14. Charge warning lamp ® p. 3-09
3. High-beam indication lamp ® p. 3-07 15. A/T (automatic transmission) fluid temperature warning lamp (vehicles
4. Front fog lamp indication lamp* ® p. 3-07 with A/T) ® p. 4-19
5. “Rear fog lamp indication lamp*” on page 3-07 16. Overdrive off indication lamp (vehicles with 4A/T) ® p. 4-19
6. Seat belt reminder/warning lamp ® p. 2-10 17. Selector lever position indicator (vehicles with A/T) ® p. 4-17, 4-24
7. Low fuel warning lamp ® p. 3-04 18. “Diesel particulate filter (DPF) warning lamp* ” on page 4-14
8. 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp* ® p. 4-28, 4-33 19. “Brake warning lamp” on page 3-08
9. Rear differential lock indication lamp* ® p. 4-35 20. “Active Stability & Traction Control (ASTC) OFF indication lamp*” on
10. Check engine warning lamp ® p. 3-08 page 4-48
11. Diesel preheat indication lamp ® p. 3-07 21. “Anti-lock brake system (ABS) warning lamp*” on page 4-45
12. Oil pressure warning lamp ® p. 3-09 22. “Active Stability & Traction Control (ASTC) indication lamp*” on page
4-48
23- “Door ajar warning lamp” on page 3-10
24. “Supplement Restraint System (SRS) warning lamp” on page 2-38
3-06 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
E00501800115
indication lamp is off.
or comes on from time to time, we rec-
This indication lamp illuminates when
ommend you to have the vehicle inspec-
the high-beam is used. NOTE ted.
l If the engine is cold, the diesel pre-
Front fog lamp indication heat indication lamp is on for a lon-
lamp* ger time.
E00501900347 l When the engine has not been star-
This indication lamp illuminates while ted within about 5 seconds after
the front fog lamps are on. the diesel preheat indication lamp
went out, return the ignition
Rear fog lamp indication switch to the “LOCK” position.
Then, turn the switch to the “ON”
lamp* position to preheat the engine
E00502000068
This indication lamp illuminates while again.
the rear fog lamp is on.
OCRE12E1 3-07
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
[Vehicles to comply with the Euro 5]
has deteriorated.
This lamp will also illuminate when the
CAUTION • Depress the brake pedal
harder than usual.
ignition switch is turned to the “ON” po-
sition, and goes off after the engine has
l In the situations listed below, Even if the brake pedal
started. If it does not go off after the en-
brake performance may be com- moves down to the very end
promised or the vehicle may be- gine has started, we recommend you to
of its possible stroke, keep it
come unstable if brakes are ap- have the system checked.
pressed down hard.
plied suddenly; consequently, • Should the brakes fail, use
avoid driving at high speeds or engine braking to reduce
applying the brakes suddenly. your speed and carefully CAUTION
Furthermore, immediately the pull the parking brake lever
vehicle should be brought to a
l Prolonged driving with this
to park your vehicle. lamp on may cause further dam-
stop in a safe location and to Depress the brake pedal to age to the emission control sys-
have it checked. operate the stop lamp to tem. It could also affect fuel
alert the vehicles behind you. economy and drivability.
3-08 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
ule accommodating the onboard di- This lamp illuminates when the ignition
l If the lamp does not illuminate switch is turned to the “ON” position,
when the ignition switch is agnostic system has various fault
data (especially about the exhaust and goes off after the engine has started.
turned to the “ON” position,
emission) stored. If it illuminates while the engine is run-
we recommend you to have the
This data will be erased if a bat- ning, the oil pressure is too low.
system checked.
tery cable is disconnected which If the warning lamp illuminates while
l If the lamp illuminates while
the engine is running, turn the engine off
the engine is running, avoid will make a rapid diagnosis diffi-
cult. Do not disconnect a battery and have it inspected.
driving at high speeds and we
recommend you to have the sys- cable when the check engine warn-
tem checked. ing lamp is ON.
During vehicle operation with CAUTION
the lamp illuminated, the vehi- l If this lamp illuminates when
cle may not accelerate when the engine oil level is not low,
Charge warning lamp
you depress the accelerator ped-
al.
E00502700821 have it inspected. 3
This lamp illuminates when the ignition l This warning lamp does not in-
When the vehicle is stationary switch is turned to the “ON” position, dicate the amount of oil in the
with the lamp illuminated, you and goes off after the engine has started. crankcase. This must be deter-
must depress the brake pedal mined by checking the oil level
more firmly than usual since
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
on the dipstick, while the en-
the engine idling speed is high-
er than usual and the vehicle
CAUTION gine is switched off.
l If you continue driving with
with an A/T has a stronger ten- l If the lamp comes on while the low engine oil level or with this
dency to creep forward. engine is running, the probable warning lamp illuminated, en-
cause is as shown below. gine seizure may occur.
Park the vehicle immediately at
a safe place and we recommend
you to have it checked. NOTE
• Broken drive belt or abnor- l The oil pressure warning lamp
mality in the charging sys- should not be treated as an indica-
tem. A broken drive belt cau- tion of the engine’s oil level. The
ses poor braking efficiency. oil level must be checked using
Depress the brake pedal the dipstick.
harder than usual to park
the vehicle in a safe place.
OCRE12E1 3-09
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
formation, we recommend you to sition, the screen switches on automatically.
consult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.
• No buzzer operation (buzzer
disabled)
• Continuous buzzer operation
3-10 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
3
1- Clock ® p. 3-19
Indicates the time.
2- Electronic compass
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
This display shows the direction of the vehicle.
3- Frozen road warning ® p. 3-16
Gives an indication when the outside temperature is 3 °C or lower.
4- Outside temperature ® p. 3-16
5- Centre information display indications
Indicates details of each display.
6- “INFO” button
Used to select various kinds of information for display.
7- Function buttons
Press this button to select options shown in the display.
8- “ADJ” button
Used for adjusting the clock and for selecting settings displays.
9- Display for function buttons
This display shows the options available for each function button.
OCRE12E1 3-11
Instruments and controls
Adjusting the time Automatic mode (MITSUBISHI genuine audio) Changing the information display
E00518000063 The automatic adjustment mode can set the local E00517900270
time automatically by using the signal from the lo- Every time the “INFO” button is pressed lightly,
cal RDS stations. In this mode, “CT” (A) (Clock the display can be changed to the following:
Time: sent with the RDS signal) is shown in the au-
dio display.
NOTE
l Automatic clock adjustment does not take
place while a settings display is shown.
Manual mode
The manual mode is also available in case the auto-
matic mode shows the incorrect time when the ad-
jacent local RDS stations are located in a different
3 Following modes are available for clock adjustment: time zone. Refer to “Radio data system (RDS)” on
page 5-18.
l For vehicles with MITSUBISHI genuine au- It is possible to manually adjust the time.
dio:
“Automatic mode” and “Manual mode” Refer to “Changing the clock settings” on page
3-19.
l Except for vehicles with MITSUBISHI genu-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ine audio:
“Manual mode” only
3-12 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- Audio information ® p. 5-13
2- Average fuel consumption ® p. 3-14
3- Driving range ® p. 3-14
4- Average speed ® p. 3-15
5- Outside temperature ® p. 3-16
6- Altimeter ® p. 3-16
7- Barometer ® p. 3-17
8- Calendar ® p. 3-18
9- Clock-only ® p. 3-18
10- Blank ® p. 3-18
OCRE12E1 3-13
Instruments and controls
Average fuel consumption l When the average fuel consumption cannot l When you turn the ignition switch to the
E00518200267 be calculated, “--.-” will be shown. “ON” position about 4 hours (or more) after
The average fuel consumption during the period
since the last reset is shown in (A) and the momen-
l The average and momentary fuel consump- turning it from the “ON” position to the
tion change depending on the driving condi- “ACC” or “LOCK” position in the auto reset
tary fuel consumption in (C). The average value of tion (road condition, driving behavior, etc.). mode, the average fuel consumption indica-
the fuel consumption is graphed every 5 minutes The indications may differ from the actual tion will automatically be reset.
and the data for up to 4 hours are shown in (B). fuel consumption. Therefore, it is recommen-
When you press the “MANUAL” function button ded to use the indications as reference.
in the auto reset mode, the mode will be changed to Driving range
the manual reset mode. When you press the “AU-
l The unit indication can be changed to your de- E00518300095
sired setting {km/L, L/100 km, mpg (UK This value (A) shows the distance (in km or miles)
TO” function button in the manual reset mode, the GALLON), or mpg (US GALLON)}. that can be driven on the fuel remaining in the fuel
mode will be changed to the auto reset mode. Refer to “User customization” on page 3-24. tank. The driving range is graphed every 5 minutes
and the data for up to 4 hours are shown in (B).
Resetting the average fuel consumption
Auto reset mode
Press the “RESET” function button to reset the aver-
age fuel consumption indication.
3
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Manual reset mode
NOTE
l When the driving range is 50 km (30 miles)
or less, the display shows “----”.
NOTE When it is 3,000 km (2,000 miles) or more,
NOTE l The average fuel consumption can be reset “3,000 km” or “2,000 miles” will be shown.
separately for the auto reset mode and for the
l When you turn the ignition switch to the
manual reset mode.
l When the driving range cannot be measured,
“ON” position after turning it from the “ON” the display shows “----”.
position to the “ACC” or “LOCK” position
in the manual reset mode, the auto reset
mode will automatically be selected.
3-14 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ing range plotted in graph. Auto reset mode
OCRE12E1 3-15
Instruments and controls
NOTE Resetting the outside temperatur When the outside air temperature drops below
l The average speed can be reset separately for Press the “RESET” function button to reset the about 3 °C (37 °F), the alarm sounds and the out-
the auto reset mode and for the manual reset graph of the outside temperature. side air temperature warning symbol (A) flashes
mode. for about 10 seconds.
l When you turn the ignition switch to the
“ON” position about 4 hours (or more) after
turning it from the “ON” position to the
“ACC” or “LOCK” position in the auto reset
mode, the average speed indication will auto-
matically be reset.
Outside temperature
E00518500097
The outside temperature is graphed every 5 mi-
nutes and the data for up to 4 hours are shown in
3 (A). The current outside temperature is shown in (B).
NOTE
l Depending on factors such as the driving con- CAUTION
ditions, the displayed temperature may vary
from the actual outside temperature. l There is a danger the road might be icy,
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l It is possible to set the display unit to °C or °F. even when this symbol is not flashing, so
Refer to “User customization” on page 3-24. please take care when driving.
Frozen road warning
This shows the temperature outside the vehicle. Altimeter
E00518600069
The current elevation in units of 100 m (400 ft) is
shown in (A). The elevation is graphed every
5 minutes and the data for up to 4 hours are shown
in (B).
3-16 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
tion using the following function buttons: This display shows the atmospheric pressure at the
atmospheric pressure. Depending on weather
present location in (A). The atmospheric pressure
conditions, the indicated elevation may differ
values are graphed every 5 minutes and the data for
from the actual elevation. Variations in atmos-
up to 4 hours are shown in (B).
pheric pressure can cause different elevations
to be shown even in the same location. This
behavior does not indicate a fault. Use the in-
dication as a guide only.
Resetting the elevation
Press the “RESET” function button to reset the ele-
vation plotted in graph.
3
“+”- Adjustment of elevation
The elevation increases by 100 m
(400 ft) every time you lightly push Resetting the atmospheric pressure
the “+” button. Press the “RESET” function button to reset the at-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
If you continue pressing the button mospheric pressure plotted in graph.
for about 2 seconds or more, the ele-
vation indication is fast-forwarded.
Then the setting is changed to the el-
evation selected.
“-”- Adjustment of elevation NOTE
The elevation decreases by 100 m
(400 ft) every time you lightly push l Pressing the “RESET” function button will
not reset the indication (C).
the “-” button.
If you continue pressing the button l It is possible to set the display unit to m or ft.
Refer to “User customization” on page 3-24.
for about 2 seconds or more, the ele-
vation indication is fast-forwarded.
Then the setting is changed to the el-
evation selected.
OCRE12E1 3-17
Instruments and controls
3 Blank
E00519000015
The whole display can be turned into blank. In this
case, buttons remain illuminated.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- Changing the clock settings ® p. 3-19
2- Adjusting the display brightness ® p. 3-20
3- Correcting the compass ® p. 3-21
Clock-only
E00518900033 4- Changing the calendar setting ® p. 3-23
Only the clock is shown. The time notation can be 5- User customization ® p. 3-24
changed to your desired setting. (12 hour/24 hour) 6- Adjusting the barometer ® p. 3-28
NOTE
l If you operate the audio system, the audio dis-
play pops up.
3-18 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
In this occasion, the display flashes twice
and then the setting is changed.
OCRE12E1 3-19
Instruments and controls
Adjusting the display brightness 2. Press the “←” or “→” function button to se- “+”- To make the display brighter
E00519300034 lect the setting you wish to adjust (daytime The display becomes brighter by one
The display brightness can be adjusted at 13 levels or nighttime). Then press the “SELECT” func- step, every time you lightly press the
for both daytime and nighttime. tion button. “+” function button. If you continue press-
l BRIGHTNESS FOR DAY TIME ing the button for about 2 seconds or
The display brightness is adjusted when the
more, the indication is fast-forwarded.
light switch is in the “OFF” position.
l BRIGHTNESS FOR NIGHT TIME “-”- To make the display darker
The display brightness is adjusted when the The display becomes darker by one step,
light switch is in the “ ” or “ ” position. every time you lightly press the
“-” function button. If you continue press-
1. Press the “ADJ” button to show the bright- ing the button for about 2 seconds or
ness adjusting display. more, the indication is fast-forwarded.
“SET”- To set the brightness
Press function button “SET” to set the
3 new brightness. The display will flash
twice.
3. Use the function buttons to adjust the bright-
ness. NOTE
l If you next wish to adjust the other adjust-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ment setting (daytime or nighttime), press
the “ADJ” button or “BACK” function button.
3-20 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
NOTE l Do not install ski racks, antennas, etc. which 1. Press the function button for “SELECT”.
l As the display brightness can be adjusted in are attached to the vehicle by means of a mag-
the center information display only, the bright- net. They affect the operation of the compass.
ness inside the meter cannot be changed.
Setting the declination
The declination is the difference between true
Correcting the compass north (the direction of the geographic north pole)
E00519400178
This compass shows the direction of the vehicle by and where a compass needle points to. Since the dec-
the 8 azimuth system. lination varies from place to place, it needs to be
set for each region. Otherwise the compass will not
show the correct direction.
Set the declination by the following steps:
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE
l This system uses the earth’s magnetic field,
and so may not show the correct direction de-
pending on the traffic condition or in the fol- NOTE
lowing places where the earth’s magnetic l The default declination setting is 0 degrees.
field is disrupted. In accordance with the illustration, set the dec-
• Car parks located in buildings and tunnels lination setting to the declination contour near-
• Expressways and underground cables est to a region where you drive the vehicle.
• Area over the subway l The declination can be set at intervals of
• Transforming station 1 degrees, from 28 degrees west (W28) to
• Areas along the railroad 28 degrees east (E28).
In these cases, the correct direction will be
displayed once the vehicle returns to a place With a settings display showing, press the “ADJ”
where the earth’s magnetic field is stable. button and select “COMPASS VARIANCE”.
OCRE12E1 3-21
Instruments and controls
3. When the declination adjustment has been NOTE 3. Turn the vehicle slowly through 360 degrees
completed, press the “SET” function button. l If your vehicle has a sunroof, keep the sun- in a safe, open area with no buildings and oth-
roof closed when calibrating the compass. er vehicles.
Having the sunroof open when calibrating
the compass could render the compass un-
able to correctly show directions.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
2. Press the function button for “SELECT”.
3-22 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
sired date every time you lightly press
the “+” function button.
If you continue pressing the button for
about 2 seconds or more, the indication
is forwarded.
NOTE
3. Use the function buttons to set the calendar. l The year changes in the following sequence:
2009 → 2010 → … 2099 → 2009.
l You can return to the previous display by
pressing the “BACK” function button.
OCRE12E1 3-23
Instruments and controls
4. After setting the date, press the “INFO” but- 2. Press function button “←” or “→” to select
ton to return to the information display. your desired indication pattern.
Type 1
NOTE
Type 2 l You can return to the previous display by
pressing the “BACK” function button.
3 Changing the calendar pattern
1. Press the “ADJ” button to select the calendar
setting display. Press the “←” or “→” func- 4. After setting the calendar pattern, press the
tion button to select “CALENDAR PAT- “INFO” button to return to the information
TERN SELECT”. Then press the “SELECT” display.
function button.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Type 3
User customization
E00519600154
You can set the indication of unit, language, and
the time notation.
In addition, you can return these settings to the fac-
tory default settings.
3-24 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Selecting the item to set Changing display units 2. Press the “←” or “→” function button to se-
1. Press the “ADJ” button to select the user cus- It is possible to change the display units for the fuel lect “km/L”. Then press the “SET” function
tomization display. consumption, driving range, average speed, outside button. The display will flash twice, and the
temperature, elevation, and atmospheric pressure display unit will be updated to the selected
as shown below. one.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
pressing the “BACK” function button.
l “12h ↔ 24h”: Changing the time format
1. Press the “←” or “→” function button to se-
l “DEFAULT”: Resetting to factory settings lect “FUEL ECONOMY”. Then press the 3. After setting, press the “INFO” button to re-
Push the function button “SELECT”. The set- “SELECT” function button. turn to the information display.
ting display for your selected item will appear.
OCRE12E1 3-25
Instruments and controls
Changing the language 2. After setting the language, press the “INFO” 12-hour 24-hour
It is possible to set the display language of the cen- button to return to the information display.
tre information display to English, Spanish,
French, German, Portuguese or Italian.
l To change the display language to English
NOTE
l You can return to the previous display by
pressing the “BACK” function button.
3 Changing the time notation
It is possible set the time notation to 12-hour or
24-hour. 2. After setting the time notation, press the “IN-
1. Press the “←” or “→” function button to se- FO” button to return to the information dis-
lect “12h TIME NOTATION” or “24h TIME play.
NOTATION”. Then press the “SET” func-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
tion button. The display will flash twice, and
the display time notation will be updated to
the selected one.
NOTE
l You can return to the previous display by
pressing the “BACK” function button.
3-26 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
NOTE 2. Press the “←” function button to select 4. Once more press the “←” function button to
l The factory settings are as follows: “YES”. select “YES”.
• Fuel consumption: L/100 km (62 mph)
• Driving range: km
• Average speed: km/h
• Outside temperature: °C
• Elevation: m
• Atmospheric pressure: hPa
• Display language: English
• Time notation: 12-hour
3. Press the “SELECT” function button. 5. Press the “SET” function button. 3
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6. The display shown below will appear, and
the display items will return to their factory
settings.
OCRE12E1 3-27
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
It is possible to adjust the barometer indication and
return it to the factory setting. ton will decrease the indicated barometer
by 2 hPa. If you continue pressing the but-
ton for about 2 seconds or longer, the in-
NOTE dication is fast-forwarded.
l It is not necessary to adjust the barometer be- “SET”- To set the barometer
cause it has been adjusted at the factory.
However, if you wish, adjust it using an accu- Press the “SET” function button. The dis-
rate barometer. play will flash twice, and the new setting
will be established.
NOTE
l You can return to the previous display by
pressing the “BACK” function button.
3. Adjust the barometer by pressing the func-
tion buttons.
3-28 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
4. After setting the barometer adjust, press the 2. Press the “SET” function button. The display 3. After setting the barometer default, press the
“INFO” button to return to the information will flash twice and the barometer indication “INFO” button to return to the information
display. will return to the factory settings. display.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
play. Then press the “SELECT” function but- l You can return to the previous display by
ton. pressing the “BACK” function button. NOTE
l Don’t use a wet cloth or abrasive cleaner as
this may cause damage.
OCRE12E1 3-29
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l When the headlamps are turned off by the au-
Type 2 tomatic on/off control with the ignition
Rotate the switch to turn on the lamps. switch in the “ON” position, the front fog
lamps (if so equipped) and rear fog lamp (if
so equipped) also go off. When the head-
lamps are subsequently turned back on by
the automatic on/off control, the front fog
lamps also come on but the rear fog lamp
stays off. If you wish to turn the rear fog
lamp back on, operate the switch again.
l Do not cover the sensor (A) for the automat-
ic on/off control by affixing a sticker or label
to the windscreen.
3-30 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
l If the lamps do not turn on or off with the l When the ignition key has been turned either When the lamp switch is in the “ ” position, the
switch in the “AUTO” position, manually op- to the “LOCK” or “ACC” position or re- beam changes from high to low (or low to high)
erate the switch and we recommend you to moved from the ignition switch with the each time the lever is pulled to (1). While the high-
have your vehicle checked. lamp switch in the “ ” position, and the beam is on, the high-beam indication lamp in the in- 3
lamp switch is returned to the “OFF” posi- strument cluster will also illuminate.
[Vehicles with Daytime Running Lamp] tion within approximately 3 minutes, the auto-
When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position cutout function will not be activated.
and the lamp switch is set to the “OFF” position,
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the low beam of the headlamps, tail lamps, etc., When you want to keep the lamps on
will illuminate. l Turn the switch in the “OFF” position to
switch off all lamps while the ignition key is
Lamps (headlamps, fog lamp, etc.) au- in the “LOCK” or “ACC” position or re-
to-cutout function move it from the ignition switch.
l If the ignition key is turned to “LOCK” or l Turn on the lamps with the switch in the
“ACC” position or removed from the igni- “ ” or “ ” position again, then the
tion switch and the lamps will stay on for lamps will remain on.
about 3 minutes without opening the driver’s
door while the lamp switch in the “ ” posi- NOTE
tion, the lamps automatically turn off. l It is possible to alter the auto-cutout function Headlamp flasher
such that: E00506300157
• Auto-cutout function is never activated. The high-beams flash when the lever is pulled slight-
For details, we recommend you to consult a ly (2), and will go off when it is released.
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service When the high-beam is on, the high-beam indica-
Point. tion lamp in the instrument cluster will also illumi-
nate.
OCRE12E1 3-31
Instruments and controls
Club cab
Vehicle condi-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
tion
CAUTION ●: 1 person
l Always perform adjustments before driv- : Full luggage loading
ing.
Do not attempt to adjust while driving, as
it could cause an accident.
NOTE
l When adjusting the beam position, first put
the dial in the “0” position (the highest beam
position).
3-32 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Switch position 0- Driver only Switch position 0- Driver only Turn-signals lever
E00506501273
Switch position 3- Driver + Full luggage load- Switch position 2- Driver + Full luggage load- The turn-signal lamps flash when the lever is oper-
ing ing ated (with the ignition switch in the “ON” posi-
{Vehicles with heavy duty {Vehicles with heavy duty tion). At the same time, the turn-signal indication
suspension} suspension for Russia, Ka- lamps flash.
zakhstan and Ukraine}
Switch position 4- Driver + Full luggage load-
ing Switch position 3- Driver + Full luggage load-
{Vehicles without heavy du- ing
ty suspension} {Vehicles with heavy duty
suspension except for Rus-
Double cab sia, Kazakhstan and Uk-
raine}
{Vehicles without heavy du-
Vehicle condi- ty suspension for Russia,
tion Kazakhstan and Ukraine} 3
Switch position 4- Driver + Full luggage load-
ing
“2” or “3” or {Vehicles without heavy du-
Switch position “0” 1- Turn-signals
“4” ty suspension except for When making a normal turn, use position
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Russia, Kazakhstan and Uk- (1). The lever will return automatically when
●: 1 person raine} cornering is completed.
: Full luggage loading There are times when the lever will not re-
turn after cornering. This occurs when the
steering wheel is turned only slightly.
In such cases, return the lever by hand.
2- Lane-change signals
When changing lanes, use position (2). It
will return to the neutral position when re-
leased.
NOTE
l If the lamp flashes unusually quickly, the
bulb in a turn-signal lamp may have burned
out. We recommend you to have the vehicle
inspected.
OCRE12E1 3-33
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE NOTE
l If the lamps are kept flashing for a long time, l The front fog lamps are automatically turned
the battery will be discharged, resulting in off when the headlamps or tail lamps are
hard engine starting or no start condition. turned off. To turn the front fog lamps on
l If the lamp flashes unusually quickly, the again, turn the knob in the “ON” direction af-
bulb in a turn-signal lamp may have burned ter turning on the headlamps or tail lamps.
out. l Do not use fog lamps except in conditions of
We recommend you to have the vehicle in- fog, otherwise excessive lamp glare may tem-
spected. porarily blind oncoming vehicle drivers.
3-34 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The knob will automatically return to its original po-
sition when you release it.
OCRE12E1 3-35
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
damaged.
Vehicles with rain sensor
E00526400369
The windscreen wipers can be operated with the ig-
nition switch in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
1- Fast
2- Slow
NOTE
l The speed-sensitive-operation function of the
windscreen wipers can be deactivated.
For further information, we recommend you
to consult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
ized Service Point.
3-36 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
If the blades are frozen to the windscreen, do not Keep the lever in the “OFF” position if the wind-
operate the wipers until the ice has melted and the screen is dirty and the weather is dry. CAUTION
blades are freed, otherwise the wiper motor may be Wiper operation under these conditions can scratch
damaged. the windscreen and damage the wipers. l With the ignition switch in the “ON” posi-
tion and the lever in the “AUTO” posi-
tion, the wipers may automatically oper-
ate in the situations described below.
If your hands get trapped, you could suf-
fer injuries or the wipers could malfunc-
tion. Be sure to turn the ignition switch to
the “OFF” position or move the lever to
the “OFF” position to deactivate the rain
sensor.
• When cleaning the outside surface of
the windscreen, if you touch the rain
sensor.
• When cleaning the outside surface of
the windscreen, if you wipe with a
3
cloth the rain sensor.
MIST- Misting function • When using an automatic car wash.
The wipers will operate once. • A physical shock is applied to the wind-
screen.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OFF- Off
• A physical shock is applied to the rain
AUTO- Auto-wiper control sensor.
Rain sensor
The wipers will automatically operate
depending on the degree of wetness on NOTE
the windscreen. l To protect the rubber parts of the wipers, this
LO- Slow operation of the wipers does not take place
when the vehicle is stationary and the ambi-
HI- Fast ent temperature is about 0 °C or lower.
Rain sensor
l Do not cover the sensor by affixing a sticker
or label to the windscreen. Also, do not put
Can only be used when the ignition switch is in the any water-repellent coating on the wind-
“ON” position. screen. The rain sensor would not be able to
If the lever is put in the “AUTO” position, the rain detect the extent of rain, and the wipers
sensor (A) will detect the extent of rain (or snow, might stop working normally.
other moisture, dust, etc.) and the wipers will oper-
ate automatically.
l In the following cases, the rain sensor may
be malfunctioning.
OCRE12E1 3-37
Instruments and controls
Have the vehicle inspected at a To adjust the sensitivity of the rain sensor If the lever is held in the upward position (MIST),
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service With the lever in the “AUTO” (rain sensor) posi- the wipers continue operating until the lever is re-
Point. tion, it is possible to adjust the sensitivity of the leased.
• When the wipers operate at a constant in- rain sensor by turning the knob (A).
terval despite changes in the extent of rain.
• When the wipers do not operate even
though it is raining.
l The wipers may automatically operate when
things such as insects or foreign objects are
affixed to the windscreen on top of the rain
sensor or when the windscreen is frozen. Ob-
jects affixed to the windscreen will stop the
wipers when the wipers cannot remove them.
To make the wipers operate again, place the
lever in the “LO” or “HI” position.
3 Also, the wipers may operate automatically
due to strong direct sunlight or electromag-
netic wave. To stop the wipers, place the lev- The wipers will operate once if the lever is moved
er in the “OFF” position. "+"- Higher sensitivity to rain to the “AUTO” position and the knob (A) is turned
l Contact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author- in the “+” direction when the ignition switch is
ized Service Point when replacing the wind- "-"- Lower sensitivity to rain “ON” position.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
screen or reinforcing the glass around the sen-
sor. NOTE
l It is possible to activate the following func-
tions. For further information, we recom-
mend you to consult a MITSUBISHI
MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
• Automatic operation (rain droplet sensi-
tive) can be changed to intermittent oper-
ation (vehicle-speed sensitive).
• Automatic operation (rain droplet sensi-
tive) can be changed to intermittent oper-
ation (except vehicle-speed sensitive).
Misting function
Move the lever in the direction of the arrow and re- Windscreen washer
lease, to operate the wipers once. E00507200805
Use this function when you are driving in mist or The windscreen washer can be operated with the ig-
drizzle. nition switch in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
3-38 OCRE12E1
Instruments and controls
The washer fluid will be sprayed onto the wind- l It is possible to cause the wipers never to op- Precautions to observe when using wip-
screen by pulling the lever towards you. The wip- erate when washer fluid is sprayed. For fur- ers and washers
ers operate automatically several times while the ther information, we recommend you to con- E00507600014
washer fluid is being sprayed. sult a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized l If the moving wipers become blocked by ice
On a vehicle equipped with a headlamp washer, the Service Point. or other deposits on the glass, the motor may
headlamp washer operates together with the wind- burn out even if the wiper switch is turned to
screen washer the first time the windscreen washer OFF. If obstruction occurs, park your vehicle
is used if the headlamps are on.
Headlamp washer switch*
E00510100273 in a safe place, turn off the ignition, and
The headlamp washer can be operated when the ig- clean the deposits from the glass so that the
nition switch is in the “ON” or “ACC” position and wipers operate smoothly.
the headlamps are on. l Do not use the wipers when the glass is dry.
They may scratch the glass surface and the
Push the button once and the washer fluid will be blades wear out prematurely.
sprayed on to the headlamps. l Before using the wipers in cold weather,
check that the wiper blades are not frozen on-
to the glass. The motor may burn out if the
wipers are used with the blades frozen onto
3
the glass.
l Avoid using the washer continuously for
more than 20 seconds. Do not operate the
washer when the fluid reservoir is empty.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Otherwise, the motor may burn out.
l Periodically check the level of washer fluid
CAUTION in the reservoir and refill if required.
During cold weather, add a recommended
l If the washer is used in cold weather, the washer solution that will not freeze in the
washer fluid sprayed against the glass
may freeze resulting in poor visibility. washer reservoir. Failure to do so could re-
Heat the glass with the defroster or demis- sult in loss of washer function and frost dam-
ter before using the washer. NOTE age to the system components.
l If the ignition switch is in the “ON” or
“ACC” position and the headlamps are on,
NOTE the headlamp washer operates together with
l It is possible to spray washer fluid without ac- the windscreen washer the first time the wind-
tivating the wipers. To do so, hold the lever screen washer lever is pulled.
in the pulled position and turn the ignition
switch to the “ON” or “ACC” position.
OCRE12E1 3-39
Instruments and controls
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Type 2
3-40 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Automatic transmission Sports Mode 5A/T.................................4-21
Easy select 4WD*.........................................................................4-26
Super select 4WD*.......................................................................4-30
Rear differential lock*..................................................................4-35
4-wheel drive operation................................................................4-39
Inspection and maintenance following rough road oper-
ation..........................................................................................4-41
Cautions on handling of 4-wheel drive vehicles..........................4-41
Limited-slip differential*..............................................................4-43
Braking.........................................................................................4-43
Brake assist system*.....................................................................4-44
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)*...................................................4-44
Power steering system..................................................................4-47
Active Stability & Traction Control (ASTC)*.............................4-47
Cruise control*.............................................................................4-50
OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Your perceptions are less accurate, your
Shift only at an appropriate speed and engine Starting of a cold engine consumes more fuel. reflexes are slower and your judgment is
speed. Always use the highest gear possible. Unnecessary fuel consumption is also caused by impaired.
The transfer shift lever should be set to “2H” when keeping a hot engine running. After the engine is
driving 4WD vehicles on normal roads and express started, commence driving as soon as possible.
ways to obtain best possible fuel economy.
Air conditioning*
City traffic The use of the air conditioning will increase the
Frequent starting and stopping increases the aver- fuel consumption.
age fuel consumption. Use roads with smooth traf-
fic flow whenever possible. When driving on con-
gested roads, avoid use of a low gear at high en-
gine speeds.
Idling
The vehicle consumes fuel even during idling.
Avoid extended idling whenever possible.
4-02 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
WARNING
l Keep floor mats clear of the pedals by cor-
rectly laying floor mats that are suitable
for the vehicle.
To prevent the floor mats from slipping
out position, securely retain them using 4
the hooks etc.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Note that laying a floor mat over a pedal
or laying one floor mat on top of another
can obstruct pedal operation and lead to
a serious accident.
OCRE12E1 4-03
Starting and driving
Running-in recommendations
E00600402395
During the running-in period for the first 1,000 km (620 miles), it is advisable to drive your new vehicle using the following precautions as a guideline to aid long
life as well as future economy and performance.
l Do not race the engine at high speeds.
l Avoid rapid starting, accelerating, braking and prolonged high-speed running.
l Keep to the running-in speed limit shown below.
Please note that the legal speed limits displayed must be adhered to.
l Do not exceed loading limits.
l Refrain from towing a trailer.
4 1st gear 20 km/h (12 mph) 20 km/h (12 mph) 10 km/h (6 mph) 20 km/h (12 mph) 10 km/h (6 mph)
2nd gear
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
40 km/h (25 mph) 40 km/h (25 mph) 20 km/h (12 mph) 40 km/h (25 mph) 20 km/h (12 mph)
3rd gear 65 km/h (40 mph) 70 km/h (43 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph) 70 km/h (43 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph)
4th gear 95 km/h (59 mph) 100 km/h (62 mph) 55 km/h (34 mph) 100 km/h (62 mph) 50 km/h (30 mph)
5th gear 120 km/h (74 mph) 130 km/h (81 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph) 130 km/h (81 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph)
4-04 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Speed limit
Shift point Vehicles with easy select 4WD Vehicles with super select 4WD
2WD
2H, 4H 4L 2H, 4H, 4HLc 4LLc
“L” (LOW) 25 km/h (16 mph) 25 km/h (16 mph) 15 km/h (9 mph) 25 km/h (16 mph) 15 km/h (9 mph)
“2” (SECOND) 65 km/h (40 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph)
“D” (DRIVE)*1 100 km/h (62 mph) 100 km/h (62 mph) 50 km/h (30 mph) 100 km/h (62 mph) 50 km/h (30 mph)
“D” (DRIVE)*2 140 km/h (87 mph) 140 km/h (87 mph) — 135 km/h (84 mph) —
*1: With overdrive switched OFF
*2: With overdrive switched ON
Vehicles with 5A/T
Shift point
Speed limit
4
2H, 4H, 4HLc 4LLc
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1st gear 25 km/h (16 mph) 10 km/h (6 mph)
2nd gear 45 km/h (28 mph) 25 km/h (16 mph)
3rd gear 70 km/h (43 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph)
4th gear 100 km/h (62 mph) 50 km/h (30 mph)
5th gear 135 km/h (84 mph) —
NOTE
l On 4WD vehicles with automatic transmission, when the transfer shift lever is in “4LLc”, the transmission will not shift into the overdrive gear.
OCRE12E1 4-05
Starting and driving
CAUTION
l On 4WD vehicles, the “4LLc” range gives maximum torque for low-speed driving on steep slopes, as well as sandy, muddy, and other difficult
surfaces. On vehicles with A/T, do not exceed speeds of approximately 70 km/h (43 mph) in “4LLc” range.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4-06 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
CAUTION
l Before driving, be sure that the parking
brake is fully released and brake warning
lamp is off.
If a vehicle is driven without releasing the 1- Firmly depress and hold the brake pedal, 1- Firmly depress and hold the brake pedal,
parking brake, the brake will be overhea- then pull the lever up without pushing the but- then pull the lever out.
ted, resulting in ineffective braking and ton at the end of hand grip.
possible brake failure. 4
l When you intend to apply the parking To release
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
brake, firmly press the brake pedal to
bring the vehicle to a complete stop be-
fore pulling the parking brake lever. Pull-
ing the parking brake lever with the vehi-
cle moving could make the rear wheels
lock up, thereby making the vehicle unsta-
ble. It could also make the parking brake
malfunction.
l If the brake warning lamp does not extin-
guish when the parking brake is fully re-
leased, the brake system may be abnormal.
Have your vehicle checked immediately.
For details, refer to “Brake warning
lamp” on page 3-08. 1- Firmly depress and hold the brake pedal,
then pull the lever up slightly.
2- Push the button at the end of hand grip.
3- Lower the lever fully.
OCRE12E1 4-07
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Set the parking brake and place the gearshift lever
into the 1st position (with M/T) or the selector lever WARNING
into the “P” (PARK) position (with A/T).
If necessary, apply chocks to wheels. l Do not park your vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as dry grass
or leaves can come in contact with a hot
NOTE exhaust, since a fire could occur.
l If your vehicle is equipped with A/T, be sure
to apply the parking brake before moving the
selector lever to the “P” (PARK) position. If
When leaving the vehicle
2- Push in the lever completely. you move the selector lever to the “P” Always remove the key from the ignition switch
(PARK) position before applying the parking and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unatten-
brake, it may be difficult to disengage the se- ded.
lector lever from the “P” (PARK) position Always try to park your vehicle in a well lit area.
when next you drive the vehicle, requiring ap-
plication of a strong force to the selector lev-
er to move from the “P” (PARK) position.
4-08 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Steering wheel height adjustment Inside rear-view mirror To reduce the glare
E00600700219 E00600800106 The lever (A) at the bottom of the mirror can be
To adjust the steering wheel height, release the tilt Adjust the rear-view mirror only after making any used to adjust the mirror to reduce the glare from
lock lever while holding the steering wheel by seat adjustments so you have a clear view to the the headlamps of vehicles behind you during night
hand, and raise or lower the steering wheel to the rear of the vehicle. driving.
desired height.
After adjustment, securely lock the lever by pulling
it upward. WARNING
l Do not attempt to adjust the rear-view
mirror while driving. This can be danger-
ous.
Always adjust the mirror before driving.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- Locked
2- Release
WARNING
l After adjusting to the desired height,
check to be sure that the lever is locked.
l Do not attempt to adjust the steering
wheel while you are driving the vehicle.
l When releasing the tilt lock lever, move it
to the release position (2) and hold the
steering wheel by hand to prevent it fall-
ing to the lowest position.
OCRE12E1 4-09
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Manual outside rear-view mirrors*
Adjust the mirror surface by hands as indicated by
the arrows. Mirror retractor switch*
The mirror retractor switch can be operated with
L- Left outside mirror adjustment the ignition switch in the “ON” or “ACC” position.
R- Right outside mirror adjustment
NOTE
l After adjustment, lightly push the switch on
the opposite side to return it to the neutral po-
sition.
4-10 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Type 1
Type 2
LOCK
NOTE The engine is stopped and the steering wheel
l It is also possible to fold and return the mir- locked. The key can only be inserted and removed
rors by hand. when the switch in this position. 4
l When freezing has occurred and mirrors fail
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
to operate as intended, please refrain from re- ACC
peated pushing of the retractor switch as this The engine is stopped, but the electrical devices
action can result in burn-out of the mirror mo- such as the radio and cigarette lighter can be operat-
tor circuits. ed.
Heated mirror* ON
E00601200253 The engine is running, and all the vehicle’s electri-
When the rear window demister switch (C) is press- cal devices can be operated.
ed, the outside rear-view mirrors are demisted or de-
frosted. Current will flow through the heater ele- START
ment inside the mirrors, thus clearing away frost or The starter motor operates. After the engine has star-
condensation. ted, release the key and it will automatically return
to the “ON” position.
OCRE12E1 4-11
Starting and driving
NOTE
CAUTION Steering wheel lock
l If your vehicle is equipped with the Daytime E00601500227
Running Lamp, when the ignition switch is l Do not remove the ignition key from the
in the “ON”, the headlamp low beams etc. ignition switch while driving. The steer-
are turned on. ing wheel will be locked, causing loss of
Refer to “Headlamps” on page 3-30. control.
l Your vehicle is equipped with an electronic l If the engine is stopped while driving, the
immobilizer. brake servomechanism will cease to func-
To start the engine, the ID code which the tion and braking efficiency will deterio-
transponder inside the key sends must match rate. Also, the power steering system will
the one registered in the immobilizer comput- not function and it will require greater
er. manual effort to operate the steering.
Refer to “Electronic immobilizer” on page l Do not leave the key in the “ON” position
1-03. for a long time when the engine is not run-
ning, doing so will cause the battery to be
To remove the key discharged.
Push the key in at the “ACC” position and keep it To lock
l Do not turn the key to the “START” posi-
Remove the key at the “LOCK” position.
depressed until it is turned to the “LOCK” position tion when the engine is running, doing so
and remove it. Turn the steering wheel until it is locked.
4 could damage the starter motor.
To unlock
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Turn the key to the “ACC” position while moving
the steering wheel slightly.
CAUTION
l Remove the key when leaving the vehicle.
NOTE
l If the front wheels are turned, the anti-theft
lock may sometimes make it difficult to turn
the key from “LOCK” to “ACC”. Firmly
turn the steering wheel to the left or to the
right as you turn the key.
4-12 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Starting CAUTION
On vehicles with automatic transmission,
make sure the selector lever in the “P”
E00601600404
(PARK) position.
l Never attempt to start the engine by push-
Tips for starting ing or pulling the vehicle. Especially the
l Do not operate the starter motor continuous- automatic transmission, since the struc- Vehicles with manual Vehicles with automatic
ly for anything longer than 10 seconds; do- ture is different from a manual transmis- transmission transmission
ing so could run down the battery. If the en- sion, it is not possible to start the engine
gine does not start, turn the ignition switch by using this technique. Never attempt
back to “LOCK” position, wait a few sec- this or it could damage the automatic
onds, and then try again. transmission.
Trying repeatedly with the starter motor still l Do not run the engine at high rpm or
turning will damage the starter mechanism. drive the vehicle at high speed until the en-
l If the engine cannot be started because the gine has had a chance to warm up.
battery is weak or dead, refer to the “Emer- l Release the ignition key as soon as the en-
gency starting” section for instructions on gine starts to avoid damaging the starter
starting the engine. motor.
l The engine is well warmed up if the coolant l Do not stop the engine immediately after
NOTE
temperature gauge needle starts to move (the high-speed or uphill driving. First allow
engine speed decreases). Extended warming- l On vehicles with automatic transmission, the
up operation will result in excessive fuel con-
the engine to idle to give the turbocharg-
er a chance to cool down.
engine will not start if the selector lever is in
any position other than “P” (PARK) or “N”
4
sumption.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
(NEUTRAL) position.
Starting the engine For safety, start the engine with the selector
WARNING 1.
E00601701792
Insert the ignition key and fasten the seat belt.
lever in the “P” (PARK) position because in
this position the rear wheels are locked in
l Never run the engine in a closed or poor- 2. Make sure the parking brake is applied. place.
ly ventilated area any longer than is nee- 3. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
ded to move your vehicle in or out of the 4. On vehicles with manual transmission, place 5. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
area. Carbon monoxide gases are odour- the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi- The diesel preheat indication lamp will first
less and can be fatal. tion and depress the clutch pedal all the way. illuminate, and then after a short time go out,
indicating that preheating is completed.
NOTE
l If the engine is cold, the diesel preheat indi-
cation lamp is on for a longer time.
OCRE12E1 4-13
Starting and driving
WARNING
6. Operate the accelerator pedal as described be-
low in accordance with the atmospheric tem- l The DPF reaches very high temperatures.
Do not park your vehicle in areas where
perature and/or engine condition and then
combustible materials such as dry grass
start the engine.
or leaves can come in contact with a hot
l When the atmospheric temperature is exhaust system since a fire could occur.
moderate or the engine is warm, start the
4 engine without depressing the accelerator
pedal.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l When the atmospheric temperature is low CAUTION If the DPF warning lamp comes on dur-
and the engine is cold, start the engine ing vehicle operation
while depressing the accelerator pedal. l Do not use any type of fuel or engine oil Steady illumination of the DPF warning lamp
that is not specified for your vehicle. Al-
shows that the DPF has not been able to burn away
so, do not use any moisture-removing
all of the trapped PM and that, as a result, an exces-
Fuel injection amount learning process agent or other fuel additive. Such substan-
sive amount of PM has accumulated inside it. To en-
E00616000028 ces could have a detrimental effect on the
To keep exhaust emissions and engine noise low, able the DPF to burn away the PM, try to drive the
DPF.
the engine very occasionally performs a learning vehicle as follows:
Refer to “Fuel selection” on page 02 and
process for the fuel injection amount. “Engine oil” on page 8-04. l With the needle of the water temperature
The engine sounds slightly different from usual gauge stabilized in roughly the middle of the
while the learning process is taking place. The scale, drive for about 20 minutes at a speed
change in the engine sound does not indicate a fault. NOTE of at least 40 km/h (24 mph).
l To minimize the likelihood of excessive ac-
cumulation of PM, try to avoid driving for If the DPF warning lamp subsequently stays on, con-
long periods at low speeds and repeatedly tact your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
driving short distances. ice Point.
4-14 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Do not move the gearshift lever into re- clutch pedal again; the shift will then be eas-
verse while the vehicle is moving for- ier to make.
ward; doing so will damage the transmis- l To shift into reverse from 5th gear, move the
sion. gearshift lever to the “N” (Neutral) position,
l Do not rest your foot on the clutch pedal and then shift it into reverse.
while driving as this will cause premature
clutch wear or damage. Changing gears
E00610600136
Always take care to change the gear with the vehi-
cle speed matched to the engine speed. Proper shift-
ing will prolong engine life.
Avoid shifting down at high speed, as this may
cause excessive engine speed (the tachometer nee-
dle into the red zone) and damage the engine.
OCRE12E1 4-15
Starting and driving
Speed limit
Shift point Vehicles with easy select 4WD Vehicles with super select 4WD
2WD
2H, 4H 4L 2H, 4H, 4HLc 4LLc
1st gear 30 km/h (19 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph) 15 km/h (9 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph) 15 km/h (9 mph)
2nd gear 60 km/h (37 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph) 35 km/h (22 mph) 65 km/h (40 mph) 30 km/h (19 mph)
3rd gear 100 km/h (62 mph) 105 km/h (65 mph) 55 km/h (34 mph) 105 km/h (65 mph) 55 km/h (34 mph)
4th gear 145 km/h (90 mph) 155 km/h (96 mph) 80 km/h (50 mph) 150 km/h (93 mph) 80 km/h (50 mph)
5th gear is an overdrive ratio and its use reduces engine speed below that of the 4th gear. Use 5 th gear whenever vehicle speed allows, for maximum fuel economy.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4-16 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
celerator pedal. or “L” (LOW)}.
The selector lever has 6 positions, and is equipped l If the lock button is always pushed to op-
with a lock button (A) to avoid inadvertent selec- erate the selector lever, the selector lever
tion of the wrong gear. may be accidentally shifted into the fol-
lowing position:
LHD: “P”, “R”, “2” or “L”
RHD: “P”, “R” or “L”
Be sure not to push the lock button when
performing the operations indicated by
in the illustration.
OCRE12E1 4-17
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
mission, and should be used when the vehicle is sta-
tionary for an extended length of time during driv- “2” SECOND
ing, such as in a traffic jam. This position is for extra power when driving up Overdrive control switch
E00604000089
moderately steep hills, and for engine braking
when descending moderately steep gradients. The overdrive control switch can be used while the
selector lever is in the “D” (DRIVE) position.
WARNING “L” LOW
During normal driving
l Never move the selector lever to the “N” This position is for driving up very steep hills and
(NEUTRAL) position while driving. A se- for engine braking at low speeds when descending Press the overdrive control switch to turn the over-
rious accident could occur since you steep gradients. drive function on. The transmission will shift auto-
could accidentally move the selector lever matically among the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th gears, ena-
into the “P” (PARK) or “R” (REVERSE) bling fuel-efficient, economical driving.
position or you will lose engine braking.
l On a gradient the engine should be star-
ted in the “P” (PARK) position, not in the
“N” (NEUTRAL) position.
4-18 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
4
Overdrive OFF indication lamp
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
E00614600017
or or
When the overdrive control switch is in the OFF po-
sition, the overdrive OFF indication lamp in the me-
ter cluster comes on.
CAUTION
l If the selector lever position indicator
blinks while you are driving, it is likely
that a safety device is operating because
of a malfunction in the automatic trans-
mission. We recommend you to have
your vehicle inspected as soon as possible.
OCRE12E1 4-19
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
key.
l Before selecting a gear with the engine
running and the vehicle stationary, fully Passing acceleration NOTE
depress the brake pedal to prevent the ve- E00604500127
hicle from creeping. To gain extra acceleration in “D” (DRIVE) posi- l On a slope, be sure to apply the parking
brake before moving the selector lever to the
The vehicle will begin to move as soon as tion (when passing another vehicle), push the accel-
“P” (PARK) position. If you move the selec-
the gear is engaged, especially when the erator to the floor. The automatic transmission will
tor lever to the “P” (PARK) position before
engine speed is high, at fast idle or with automatically downshift.
applying the parking brake, it may be diffi-
the air conditioning operating, the brakes cult to disengage the selector lever from the
should only be released when you are Waiting
E00604600128 “P” (PARK) position when next you drive
ready to drive away. For short waiting periods, such as at traffic signals, the vehicle, requiring application of a strong
l Depress the brake pedal with the right the vehicle can be left in gear and held stationary force to the selector lever to move from the
foot at all times. with the service brake. “P” (PARK) position.
Using the left foot could cause driver move- For longer waiting periods with the engine running,
ment delay in case of an emergency. the selector lever should be placed in the “N” (NEU-
TRAL) position.
4-20 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
When the automatic transmission makes no speed Automatic transmission Sports NOTE
change l For information on manual gate operation,
E00604800478 Mode 5A/T please refer to “Sports mode” on page 4-23.
If the transmission does not change speeds while E00603200576
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the speed of the vehicle and the position of the ac-
celerator pedal.
The selector lever has 2 gates; the main gate (1)
and the manual gate (2).
OCRE12E1 4-21
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Selector lever positions (Main gate) (NEUTRAL), to minimize the risk of loss
E00603800585 of control.
4-22 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
and/or rapid acceleration can cause a loss In sports mode, the currently selected position is in-
ward. In contrast to a manual transmission, the dicated by the indicator (A) shown on the instru-
sports mode allows gear shifts with the accelerator of traction, downshifts must be made care-
fully in accordance with the vehicle’s ment panel.
pedal depressed.
speed.
NOTE
l In sports mode, only the 5 forward gears can
SHIFT UP be selected. To reverse or park the vehicle,
move the selector lever to the “R” (RE- 4
VERSE) or “P” (PARK) position as required.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l To maintain good running performance, the
transmission may refuse to perform an up-
shift when the selector lever is moved to the
SHIFT DOWN “+ (SHIFT UP)” position at certain vehicle
speeds. Also, to prevent over-revving of the
+ (SHIFT UP) engine, the transmission may refuse to per-
Push the lever forward once to shift up one gear. form a downshift when the lever is moved to
the “- (SHIFT DOWN)” position at certain
- (SHIFT DOWN) vehicle speeds.
Pull the lever backward once to shift down one l In sports mode, downward shifts are made au-
gear. tomatically when the vehicle slows down.
When the vehicle stops, 1st gear is automati-
cally selected.
OCRE12E1 4-23
Starting and driving
CAUTION
4 l Before selecting a gear with the engine
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
running and the vehicle stationary, fully
or through
depress the brake pedal to prevent the ve-
hicle from creeping.
The vehicle will begin to move as soon as
the gear is engaged, especially when the
engine speed is high, at fast idle or with
the air conditioning operating, the brakes
CAUTION should only be released when you are
ready to drive away.
l If the selector lever position indicator l Depress the brake pedal with the right
blinks while you are driving, it is likely foot at all times.
that a safety device is operating because Using the left foot could cause driver move-
of a malfunction in the automatic trans- ment delay in case of an emergency.
mission. We recommend you to have l To prevent sudden acceleration, never
your vehicle inspected as soon as possible. race the engine when shifting from the
“P” (PARK) or “N” (NEUTRAL) position.
4-24 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
stop, fully engage the parking brake, and then as possible.
Passing acceleration move the selector lever to the “P” (PARK) position. 1. If your vehicle has difficulty moving uphill,
E00604500329 If you are going to leave the vehicle unattended, al- shift the selector lever into 2nd gear of the
To gain extra acceleration in “D” (DRIVE) posi- ways switch off the engine and remove the ignition
tion, push the accelerator to the floor. The automat- “Sports mode”.
key. This method might not work depending on
ic transmission will automatically downshift.
the type of transmission malfunction.
2. Once the vehicle is moving on a level road,
NOTE move the selector lever back to “D” (DRIVE).
l In “Sports mode”, downshifts do not take
place when the accelerator is depressed all
the way to the floor. NOTE
l When the selector lever position indicator in
the instrument panel blinks, it means that
Waiting there is an abnormal condition in the trans-
E00604600304
For short waiting periods, such as at traffic signals, mission. Refer to “When the selector lever po-
the vehicle can be left in gear and held stationary sition indicator blinks” on page 4-19.
with the service brake.
OCRE12E1 4-25
Starting and driving
Easy select 4WD* Transfer shift lever position and 2WD/ NOTE
E00614700119 4WD operation indication lamp l On vehicles with automatic transmission,
Shifting to rear-wheel drive or 4-wheel drive can E00614800080 when the transfer shift lever is in “4L”, the
be made by operating the transfer shift lever (A). transmission will not shift into the overdrive
Shift the transfer shift lever to an appropriate posi- 2WD/4WD gear.
Transfer shift lever Driving con-
tion according to the road surface conditions. In ad- operation in-
position ditions
dition, the 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp in- dication lamp
dicates the transfer shift lever shifting state. Refer
to “2WD/4WD operation indication lamp” on page
CAUTION
When driv- l The “4L” range gives maximum torque
4-28. Rear-wheel
2H ing on dry for lowspeed driving on steep slopes, as
drive
paved road. well as sandy, muddy, and other difficult
Vehicles with manual transmission surfaces. On vehicles with automatic
transmission, do not exceed speeds of ap-
When driv-
proximately 70 km/h (43 mph) in “4L”
ing on rough,
4-wheel range.
4H sand or snow
drive
covered l Do not drive your vehicle in the “4H” or
“4L” on dry paved roads and highways.
roads.
Doing so may result in excessive tyre
4 Vehicles with automatic transmission When driv- wear, increased fuel consumption, and
possible noise generation. It may also in-
ing up or
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
down steep crease the differential oil temperature,
hills, on which may damage the drive system. Fur-
rough or ther, the drive train will be subjected to
Low range 4- excessive loading, resulting in oil leakage,
4L muddy roads
wheel drive component seizure, or other serious prob-
(especially
when in- lems. On dry paved roads and highways,
creased tor- drive the vehicle in “2H” only.
que is re-
quired).
: Illuminate
: Remain off
4-26 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Transfer shift lever operation The transfer shift lever should be positioned in ac-
E00614900111 cordance with the following operating conditions:
The shift pattern is shown on the transfer shift lev-
er knob.
Procedure
To shift from To
2H 4H
Vehicles with manual transmission Vehicles with automatic transmission
The transfer shift lever can be operated while the vehicle
4
The transfer shift lever can be operated while the vehicle is
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
is either moving or stationary.
either moving or stationary.
When the vehicle is not in motion, shift the selector lever
When the vehicle is not in motion, shift the gearshift lever
to the “N” (NEUTRAL) position before operating the
to the “N” (Neutral) position before operating the transfer
transfer shift lever.
4H 2H shift lever.
When the vehicle is moving, and only while it can be
When the vehicle is moving, and only while it can be
steered straight ahead, shift the selector lever to the “D”
steered straight ahead, release the accelerator pedal before
(DRIVE) position, and release the accelerator pedal be-
operating the transfer shift lever.
fore operating the transfer shift lever.
4H 4L Stop the vehicle, shift the selector lever to the “N” (NEU-
TRAL) position, and operate the transfer shift lever.
Stop the vehicle, depress the clutch pedal to the floor and If operation is made with the selector lever placed in any
4L 4H operate the transfer shift lever. other position than “N” (NEUTRAL) position, a gear
noise may be generated, with a possible failure to shift in-
to a proper gear.
OCRE12E1 4-27
Starting and driving
NOTE 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp Except for vehicles for Russia and Ukraine
l Shifting of the transfer shift lever between E00615000092
“2H” ↔ “4H”
“2H” ↔ “4H” should only be done at speeds
below 100 km/h (62 mph). Transfer shift lever posi- 2WD/4WD operation
l During driving, never attempt to shift from tion indication lamp
“4H” to “4L”.
l When shifting from “2H” to “4H” in cold
weather while the vehicle is in motion, the
transmission gear may make some noise. In
cold weather, try to shift the gear while the
vehicle is stopped.
l There may be a case that the transfer shift lev- 2H
er feels heavy when it is moved from “4H”
to “2H” with the steering wheel in turned po-
sition.
This is normal and not any indication of trou-
ble. When the ignition switch is in the “ON” position,
the 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp shows
the shifting condition. The 2WD/4WD operation in-
4 CAUTION dication lamp comes on at each transfer shift lever
position as follows:
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Do not operate the transfer shift lever
while the rear wheels of the vehicle are
slipping on snow or ice.
Drive mode switching
in progress
4H
: Blink
4-28 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
switching in 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp is
progress switched.
• If the 2WD/4WD operation indication
lamp does not switch after a “2H” ↔
“4H” selection has been made with the ve-
hicle moving, hold the steering wheel in
the straight ahead position and slowly de-
press the accelerator pedal several times.
4H
: Illuminate
: Remain off
OCRE12E1 4-29
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
in progress
4L
: Illuminate
: Remain off
4-30 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Transfer shift lever position and 2WD/ : Illuminate Transfer shift lever operation
4WD operation indication lamp : Remain off E00605900173
The shift pattern is shown on the transfer shift lev-
E00605800228
er knob.
2WD/4WD NOTE
Transfer shift lever operation in- Driving con- l On vehicles with automatic transmission,
position dication ditions when the transfer shift lever is in “4LLc”, the
lamp transmission will not shift into the overdrive
gear.
When driv-
Rear-wheel
2H ing on dry
drive
paved road. CAUTION
The basic l The “4LLc” range gives maximum tor-
position for que for low-speed driving on steep slopes,
super select as well as sandy, muddy, and other diffi-
4WD. cult surfaces. On vehicles with automatic
Full-time 4- transmission, do not exceed speeds of ap-
4H When driv-
wheel drive proximately 70 km/h (43 mph) in “4LLc”
ing on dry The transfer shift lever should be positioned in ac-
range.
paved
slippery
or
l Do not drive your vehicle in the “4HLc”
cordance with the following operating conditions:
: Not push down the transfer shift lever
4
or “4LLc” on dry paved roads and high-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
roads. : Push down the transfer shift lever
ways. Doing so may result in excessive
Centre dif- When driv- tyre wear, increased fuel consumption,
ferential ing on and possible noise generation. It may also
4HLc lock engag- rough, sand increase the differential oil temperature,
ed 4-wheel or snow cov- which may damage the drive system. Fur-
drive ered roads. ther, the drive train will be subjected to
When driv- excessive loading, resulting in oil leakage,
ing up or component seizure, or other serious prob-
down steep lems. On dry paved roads and highways,
Low range hills, on drive the vehicle in “2H” or “4H” only.
centre differ- rough or
4LLc ential lock muddy
engaged 4- roads (espe-
wheel drive cially when
increased
torque is re-
quired).
OCRE12E1 4-31
Starting and driving
Procedure
To shift from To
Vehicles with manual transmission Vehicles with automatic transmission
2H 4H The transfer shift lever can be operated while the vehicle
The transfer shift lever can be operated while the vehicle is
is either moving or stationary.
4H 2H or 4HLc either moving or stationary.
When the vehicle is not in motion, shift the selector lever
When the vehicle is not in motion, shift the gearshift lever
to the “N” (NEUTRAL) position before operating the
to the “N” (Neutral) position before operating the transfer
transfer shift lever.
shift lever.
When the vehicle is moving, and only while it can be
4HLc 4H When the vehicle is moving, and only while it can be
steered straight ahead, shift the selector lever to the “D”
steered straight ahead, and release the accelerator pedal be-
(DRIVE) position, and release the accelerator pedal be-
fore operating the transfer shift lever.
fore operating the transfer shift lever.
4HLc 4LLc Stop the vehicle, shift the selector lever to the “N” (NEU-
Stop the vehicle, depress the clutch pedal to the floor and TRAL) position, and operate the transfer shift lever
operate the transfer shift lever while keeping the transfer while keeping the transfer shift lever pushed down.
shift lever pushed down. If operation is made with the selector lever placed in any
4LLc 4HLc Keep depressing the clutch pedal while the 2WD/4WD op- other position than “N” (NEUTRAL) position, a gear
eration indication lamp continues to blink. noise may be generated, with a possible failure to shift in-
4 to a proper gear.
NOTE l When the transfer shift lever is shifted from l There may be a case that the transfer shift lev-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Shifting of the transfer shift lever between “4H” to “4HLc” while the vehicle is stopped, er feels heavy when it is moved from “2H”
“2H” ↔ “4H” should only be done at speeds the 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp to “4H” with the steering wheel in turned po-
below 100 km/h (62 mph). blinks while the selection is in process. Drive sition.
l During driving, never attempt to shift from slowly and normally after confirming that This is normal and not any indication of trou-
“4HLc” to “4LLc”. the lamp is illuminated. (Refer to “2WD/ ble.
l When shifting from “2H” to “4H” in cold 4WD operation indication lamp” on page
weather while the vehicle is in motion, the 4-33.)
transmission gear may make some noise. In l Do not move the selector lever while the 2WD/ CAUTION
cold weather, try to shift the gear while the 4WD operation indication lamp is blinking.
vehicle is stopped. l The 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp l Do not operate the transfer shift lever
will go out momentarily during shifting proc- while the rear wheels of the vehicle are
ess from “4HLc” to “4LLc” or vice versa, as slipping on snow or ice.
the transfer shift lever passes through the neu-
tral position.
Be sure to operate the transfer shift lever un-
til the 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp
illuminates again.
4-32 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
2H 4H
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the shifting condition. The 2WD/4WD operation in-
dication lamp comes on at each transfer shift lever
position as follows:
4HLc
4H
: Blink
: Blink : Illuminate
: Illuminate : Remain off
: Remain off
OCRE12E1 4-33
Starting and driving
“4HLc” ↔ “4LLc” the following precautions when the indica- l When you move the transfer shift lever from
tion lamp is blinking or remains off. “4H” to “4HLc”, there may be a slight delay
Transfer shift lever posi- 2WD/4WD operation • Keep the steering wheel in the straight before the centre differential lock lamp illu-
tion indication lamp ahead position while making range selec- minates.
tions. If you attempt to drive forward
with the steering wheel turned, gear rat-
tling may occur and the desired range
4HLc may not actually be selected.
• If you move the transfer shift lever from
“4H” to “4HLc” while the vehicle is sta-
tionary, keep your speed initially very
low when you subsequently make a stand-
ing start. Before driving at normal
speeds, confirm that the centre differen-
tial lock lamp has changed from blinking
to steady illumination.
Drive mode switching • If you move the transfer shift lever from
in progress “4HLc” to “4H” and the centre differen-
tial lock lamp does not stop blinking,
4 place the steering wheel in the straight
ahead position and slowly depress the ac-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
celerator pedal several times.
• If you move the transfer shift lever from
“4H” to “2H” and the front wheel lamp
does not stop blinking, confirm safety
around the vehicle then accelerate, decel-
4LLc erate, and reverse until the front wheel
lamp goes off. When the front wheel
lamp goes off, you can then proceed to
: Blink drive the vehicle.
: Illuminate If you accelerate, decelerate, and reverse
but the front wheel lamp still does not
: Remain off
stop blinking, return the transfer shift lev-
er to “4H” then have your vehicle inspec-
NOTE ted.
l The 2WD/4WD operation indication lamp
blinks while the selection is in process. Take
4-34 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
CAUTION
l Operate the rear differential lock switch
after the wheels are stopped. Operating 4
the switch with the wheels turning may
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Operating the rear differential lock cause the vehicle to dart in unexpected di-
1. Move the transfer shift lever to “4L” or “4H” rections. Super select 4WD
position (easy select 4WD), “4LLc” or
“4HLc” position (super select 4WD).
2. To activate the rear differential lock, press NOTE
the rear differential lock switch (1). l The rear differential lock does not operate
when the transfer shift lever is in “2H” posi-
tion (easy select 4WD), “2H” or “4H” posi-
tion (super select 4WD).
l When the rear differential is locked with the
transfer shift lever in “4L” or “4H” position
(easy select 4WD), “4LLc” or “4HLc” posi-
tion (super select 4WD) changing the shift
lever to “2H” position (easy select 4WD),
“2H” or “4H” position (super select 4WD)
makes the rear differential unlock automati-
cally.
OCRE12E1 4-35
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
(ABS), the ABS function is suspended while
the rear differential lock is activated.
The ABS warning lamp is illuminated while
ABS functionality is suspended.
Refer to “ABS warning lamp” on page 4-45.
l If the indication lamp continues blinking af-
Rear differen- ter the switch has been pressed to deactivate
tial lock activa- the rear differential lock, hold the steering
ted wheel in the straight ahead position then slow-
ly depress and release the accelerator pedal
: Blink several times.
: Illuminate (steady) l If the indication lamp continues blinking af-
ter the switch has been pressed to activate
: Remain off
the rear differential lock, bear in mind the fol-
lowing instructions:
4-36 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
• If the vehicle speed is 12 km/h (7 mph) When one of the wheels has fallen in a ditch When getting out of snow
or higher, decelerate to a speed of 6 km/h When the vehicle is unable to get going because
(4 mph) or lower. The indication lamp one of the wheels is on the snow and the other on a
will illuminate steadily and the rear differ- paved road.
ential lock will be activated.
• If the vehicle speed is 12 km/h (7 mph)
or lower, turn the steering wheel from
side to side until the indication lamp illu-
minates steadily. If the vehicle is stuck in
soft ground, make sure the area around
the vehicle is clear then repeatedly at-
tempt to drive forward and backward.
The indication lamp will illuminate stead-
ily and the rear differential lock will be ac-
tivated.
When driving on rocky roads
When the vehicle is unable to move because one of
Examples of effective use of the rear the wheels is suspended in the air.
differential lock Examples of incorrect use of the rear
E00606400058
differential lock 4
E00606500059
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
CAUTION
l Use the rear differential lock only as an WARNING
emergency measure when the vehicle is
stuck and cannot be freed with the trans- l If the “4L” or “4H” position (easy select
fer shift lever in “4L” or “4H” position 4WD), “4LLc” or “4HLc” position (super
(easy select 4WD) or in “4LLc” or select 4WD) is selected along with the
“4HLc” position (super select 4WD). De- rear differential lock, the following phe-
activate the rear differential lock immedi- nomena appear and it is very dangerous.
ately after using it. Please be sure to release the rear differen-
tial lock on normal roads.
OCRE12E1 4-37
Starting and driving
WARNING
• If the rear differential lock is used by
mistake when driving on a paved
road: With the rear differential lock
on, the power to drive the vehicle
straight ahead becomes very strong,
which may make it difficult to turn
the steering wheel.
WARNING
l If the rear differential lock is used by mis-
take except when making an emergency
escape on snow or frozen road: It be-
comes difficult to make a steady turn.
4 l In the case where the condition of the
road is different for the right tyre to
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
drive from the left tyre (such as one tyre
on a paved road and the other on ice), di-
rection of the vehicle may change abrupt-
WARNING ly when engine braking or accelerating.
Do not use the rear differential lock ex-
l If the rear differential lock is used by mis- cept when making an emergency escape
take when turning a curve or making a on a snow or frozen road, but drive with
right or left turn at a crossing or the like: 4WD.
The vehicle is unable to make a turn and
may go straight ahead.
4-38 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l After driving on rough roads, check each tions, and then gradually depress the accelerator ped- • The needle in the temperature gauge
part of the vehicle and wash it thoroughly al for a smooth start. approaches the overheating zone.
with water. Refer to the “Vehicle care” sec- Refer to “Engine overheating” on
tion and “Inspection and maintenance follow- page 6-04.
ing rough road operation” on page 4-41. NOTE
• Automatic transmission fluid temper-
l The use of snow tyres and/or tyre chains is
ature warning lamp comes on.
Driving on dry paved road and highway recommended.
Refer to “When the A/T (automatic
Select “2H” position (easy select 4WD), “2H” or l Maintain a safe distance between vehicles,
transmission) fluid temperature warn-
“4H” position (super select 4WD) to drive on the avoid sudden braking, and use engine brak-
ing lamp comes on” on pages 4-19,
dry paved road. Especially on dry highway, never ing (downshifting).
4-24.
select the “4H” or “4L” position (easy select
4WD), “4HLc” or “4LLc” position (super select
4WD). CAUTION
l Avoid sudden braking, sudden accelera-
tion, and sharp turning; such operations
could cause skidding and spinouts.
OCRE12E1 4-39
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the accelerator pedal. NOTE pend on the skill and experience of the opera-
l It is recommended to start the vehicle with tor and other participating parties and any de-
parking brake partially, but not completely,
l Choose as smooth a slope as possible with
viation from the recommended operation in-
few stones or other obstacles.
applied by slightly pulling the parking brake structions above is at their own risk.
lever.
l Before attempting to drive up the slope, walk
up it to confirm that the vehicle can handle
After the vehicle has become free, do not for- the grade. Turning sharp corners
get to release the parking brake. When turning a sharp corner in “4H” or “4L” posi-
l If it is necessary to drive in extremely muddy
Descending sharp grades tion (easy select 4WD), “4HLc” or “4LLc” posi-
conditions, the use of tyre chains is recom- tion (super select 4WD) at low speed, a slight dif-
Set the transfer shift lever to “4L” position (easy se-
mended. Because the extent of muddy condi- ference in steering may be experienced similar to
lect 4WD), “4LLc” position (super select 4WD),
tions is difficult to judge and the vehicle as if the brakes were applied. This is called tight cor-
use the engine brake (downshifting) and descend
could become bogged down very deeply, op- ner braking and results from each of the 4 tyres be-
slowly.
eration should be at a low speed. If possible, ing at a different distance from the corner.
get out of the vehicle and check the condi- The phenomenon is peculiar to 4-wheel drive vehi-
tions ahead before proceeding. cles. If this occurs, either straighten the steering
wheel, or change to rear-wheel drive.
4-40 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
• Check the brake system and, if necessary,
l Never cross a stream where the water is have it serviced.
deep. Good vehicle performance cannot be expected if
Do not change gears while crossing the • Check the engine, transmission, transfer, there is a difference in wear between tyres. Refer to
stream. and differential oil or grease level and tur- “Tyre rotation” on page 8-13.
Frequent crossing of streams can adverse- bidity. If the oil or grease is milky, it indi-
cates water contamination. Replace it l Check the tyre inflation pressure regularly.
ly affect the life span of the vehicle; we rec-
ommend you to take the necessary meas- with new oil or grease.
ures to prepare, inspect, and repair the ve- • Grease the propeller shaft.
hicle. • Check the inside of the vehicle. If ingress
of water is found, dry the carpet etc.
• Inspect the headlamps. If the headlamp
After crossing a stream, apply the brakes to be sure bulb is flooded with water, we recom-
they are functioning properly. If the brakes are wet mend you to have it drained.
and not functioning properly, dry them out by driv-
ing slowly while lightly depressing the brake pedal.
Inspect each part of the vehicle carefully.
OCRE12E1 4-41
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
move or abnormal noise is produced.
l Inspection of the vehicle’s underside reveals
that oil or some other fluid is leaking. WARNING
l Do not crank the engine while jacking up
the vehicle.
The tyre on the ground may turn and the
vehicle may roll off the jack.
Clutch operation
Quick or slight clutch engagement made while the
engine is running at high speed will cause damage
to the clutch and transmission because the tractive
force is very great.
Operate the pedal slowly and positively.
4-42 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
er assist for some reason, the brakes will still work. brakes out by driving slowly while lightly depress-
ing the brake pedal.
CAUTION In these situations, even if the brake pedal moves
down to the very end of its possible stroke or re-
l Never start the engine while one of the sists being depressed, keep depressing the brake ped- When driving downhill
rear wheels is jacked up and the other in al down harder and further than usual; stop driving It is important to take advantage of the engine brak-
contact with the ground; doing so may as soon as possible and have the brake system re- ing by shifting to a lower shift position while driv-
cause the vehicle to jump forward. paired. ing on steep downhill roads in order to prevent the
l When attempting to extract the vehicle brakes from overheating.
from snow, mud, etc., and the engine is
run continuously at high speed, the limi- WARNING
ted-slip differential will be adversely af-
fected. l Do not turn off the engine while your ve-
hicle is in motion. If you turn off the en-
gine while driving, the power assistance
for the braking system will stop working
and your brakes will not work effectively.
OCRE12E1 4-43
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Once the brake assist system is operational,
hicle not equipped with ABS.
it maintains great braking force even if the
Compared with vehicles not fitted with ABS,
WARNING brake pedal is lightly released.
To stop its operation, completely remove your vehicle may require a longer stopping
l Driving with worn brake pads will make your foot from the brake pedal. distance in the following cases:
it harder to stop, and can cause an acci- • Driving on gravel or snow-covered roads.
l When the brake assist system is in use while
• Driving with tyre chains installed.
dent. driving, you may feel the brake pedal at-
tempt to resist, the pedal moves in small mo- • Driving on roads where the road surface
tions in conjunction with the operation noise, is pitted or has other differences in sur-
or the vehicle body and the steering wheel vi- face height.
brate. This occurs when the brake assist sys- • Driving on bumpy roads or other poor driv-
tem is operating normally and does not indi- ing surfaces.
cate faulty operation. Continue to firmly de-
press the brake pedal.
l When the active stability & traction control
(ASTC) indication lamp is illuminated, the
brake assist system may not function.
4-44 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Even the ABS cannot prevent the natural It does not indicate a problem. When the rear
laws of physics from acting on the vehi-
differential lock is disengaged, these lamps
cle. It cannot for instance avoid accidents
go out and function again.
that may result from excessive speed on
Refer to “ASTC indication lamp, ASTC OFF
bends or following another vehicle too
indication lamp” on page 4-48.
closely or aquaplaning. It should remain
the driver’s task to observe safety precau- l On vehicles with rear differential lock, ABS
functionality is suspended while the rear dif-
tions to judge speeds and brake applica-
ferential lock is operating.
tions correctly in such conditions.
The ABS warning lamp is illuminated while
l Be sure to use tyres of the same type and
ABS functionality is suspended. It does not
size on 4 wheels.
indicate a problem. When the rear differen-
If tyre types or sizes are mixed, ABS may
tial lock is disengaged, the ABS warning
not function normally.
lamp goes off and the ABS functions again.
Refer to “Rear differential lock” on page
4-35.
OCRE12E1 4-45
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
If the battery has been charged but the ABS
warning lamp continues to illuminate or illu-
minates intermittently, have the vehicle in-
spected.
4-46 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Power steering system Active Stability & Traction l Some vibration will be felt in the vehicle
body and a whining sound of a motor will be
E00607400260
The power steering system operates while the en- Control (ASTC)* heard from the engine compartment when
E00616700344
gine is running. It helps reduce the effort needed to the ASTC functions. This is a normal result
The active stability & traction control (ASTC)
turn the steering wheel. of the ASTC operation, and does not indicate
takes overall control of the anti-lock brake system,
The power steering system has mechanical steering a malfunction.
traction control function and Active Stability Con-
capability in case the power assist is lost. If the pow-
trol function to help maintain the vehicle’s control l The ASTC does not operate while the ABS
er assist is lost for some reason, you will still be warning lamp is illuminated.
and traction. Please read this section in conjunction
able to steer your vehicle. If the power assist is with the page on the anti-lock brake system, trac- l On vehicles with the rear differential lock,
lost, you will notice it takes much more effort to the ASTC and ABS functions are suspended
tion control function and Active Stability Control
steer and that there is much more “free play” in the while the rear differential lock is activated.
function.
steering wheel. If this happens, take your vehicle to ASTC indication lamp, ASTC OFF indica-
an authorized MITSUBISHI MOTORS dealer. tion lamp and ABS warning lamp are illumi-
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) ® p. 4-44 nated while these functions are suspended. It
Active Traction Control function ® p. 4-48 does not indicate a problem. When the rear
Active Stability Control function ® p. 4-48
WARNING differential lock is disengaged, these lamps
go out and function again.
l Do not stop the engine while the vehicle is Refer to “ABS warning lamp” on page 4-45,
moving. Stopping the engine would make CAUTION “ASTC indication lamp, ASTC OFF indica-
the steering wheel extremely hard to
turn, possibly resulting in an accident. l Do not over-rely on the ASTC. This sys-
tion lamp” on page 4-48. 4
tem, like any other system, has limits and
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
cannot help you to maintain traction and Driving hints
control of the vehicle in all circumstan- E00616800039
CAUTION ces. Reckless driving may lead to acci- When extricating the vehicle from mud, sand or
dents. Always drive carefully, taking into fresh snow, you may find that operation of the
l Do not leave the steering wheel turned all account the traffic, road and environmen- ASTC prevents the engine speed from increasing
the way in one direction. This can cause in response to depression of the accelerator pedal.
damage to the power steering system. tal conditions.
l Be sure to use the same specified type and If this happens and the vehicle remains stuck as a
size of tyre on all 4 wheels. Otherwise, the result, deactivate the ASC function by pressing the
ASTC may not work correctly. “ASC OFF” switch. The vehicle will then be easier
to extricate. (Brake control of the ATC function is
still working to prevent wheel spins when the ASC
NOTE function is deactivated by pressing the “ASC OFF”
l After your vehicle is driven a short distance switch.)
after starting the engine, a click is heard from
the engine compartment; however, this is on-
ly the sound of ASTC being checked.
OCRE12E1 4-47
Starting and driving
Active Stability Control function “ASC OFF” switch Active Traction Control function
E00616900056 The Active Stability Control function is automati- E00617000025
The Active Stability Control function is designed cally activated when the ignition switch is turned to On slippery surfaces, active traction control func-
to improve the vehicle’s stability by restraining its the “ON” position. You can deactivate the system tion prevents the drive wheels from excessive spin-
tendency to slip sideways (for example, when round- by pressing the “ASC OFF” switch when the vehi- ning, thus helping the vehicle to start moving from
ing a curve in slippery conditions, or when the driv- cle speed is below about 40 km/h (25 mph). To re- a stop. It also provides sufficient driving force and
er takes rapid steering action to avoid an obstacle). activate the Active Stability Control function, press steering performance as the vehicle turns at acceler-
It works by controlling the engine output and brake the “ASC OFF” switch again. It is strongly recom- ated speeds.
on each wheel. mended that the Active Stability Control function
normally be kept activated.
NOTE CAUTION
l On vehicles with the rear differential lock, Type 1
l When driving a vehicle on a snowy or icy
the Active Stability Control function does road, be sure to install snow tyres and
not operate when the rear differential lock is drive the vehicle at moderate speeds.
activated.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
lamp.
The indication lamps should illuminate when the ig-
nition switch is turned to the “ON” position and
should go off after a few seconds.
If the indication lamps stay on or do not illuminate
when the ignition switch is turned to the “ON” po-
sition, we recommend you to have your vehicle in-
spected as soon as possible.
NOTE indication lamp blinks when the Active Stabili-
l If the vehicle speed increases to about ty Control function or active traction control func-
120 km/h (74 mph) with the Active Stability tion is operating.
Control function deactivated, the Active Sta-
bility Control function automatically starts op-
erating. To subsequently stop the Active Sta-
bility Control function, stop the vehicle and
press the “ASC OFF” switch again.
4-48 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
tion control function is operating, which is followed, there could be a problem raised, keep the ignition switch in the
means that the road is slippery or that in the system. “LOCK” or “ACC” position. When tow-
your vehicle’s wheels are slipping exces- Stop the engine and start the engine ing the vehicle with the rear wheels
sively. If this happens, drive slower with again and check whether the indi- raised, keep the ignition switch in the
less accelerator input. cation lamp goes out. If the indication “ACC” position.
l If an abnormal condition occurs in the sys- lamp goes out, there is no abnormal Refer to “Towing” on page 6-20.
tem while driving, the indication lamp condition.
will illuminate. If the indication lamp illuminates
In these cases, follow these procedures: even after your vehicle is driven a
short distance after restarting the en-
gine, we recommend you to have your
vehicle checked as soon as possible.
OCRE12E1 4-49
Starting and driving
CAUTION
l When you do not wish to drive at a set
speed, turn off the cruise control for safety.
l Do not use cruise control when driving
conditions will not allow you to stay at
the same speed, such as in heavy traffic
or on roads that are winding, icy, snow-
covered, wet, slippery, on a steep down-
hill slope. A- “ON OFF” switch
l On vehicles with manual transmission, do Used to turn on and off the cruise control.
not move the gearshift lever to the “N”
4 (Neutral) position while driving at a set
speed without depressing the clutch ped-
B- “COAST SET” switch
Used to reduce the set speed and to set the desired
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
al. The engine will run too fast and might speed.
be damaged.
C- “ACC RES” switch
Used to increase the set speed and to return to the
NOTE original set speed. NOTE
l Cruise control may not be able to keep your l If the cruise control is on when the ignition
speed on uphills or downhills. D- “CANCEL” switch switch is turned to the “LOCK” or “ACC” po-
l Your speed may decrease on a steep uphill. Used to deactivate the set speed driving. sition, cruise control will be on automatically
You may use the accelerator pedal if you
the next time you start the engine.
want to stay at your set speed.
NOTE The “CRUISE” indication lamp will also be
l Your speed may increase to more than the
on.
set speed on a steep downhill. You must use l When operating the cruise control switches,
the brake to control your speed. As a result, press the cruise control switches correctly. l If the battery voltage is insufficient, the mem-
The set speed driving may be deactivated au- ory data for the cruise control may be erased.
the set speed driving is deactivated.
tomatically if two or more switches of the As a result, the “CRUISE” indication lamp
cruise control are pressed at the same time. may not come on when you restart the engine.
If this happens, press the “ON OFF” switch
once again to turn on the cruise control.
4-50 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
2. Accelerate or decelerate to your desired When you reach your desired speed, release the Accelerator pedal
speed, then press and release the “COAST switch. Your new cruising speed is now set. While driving at the set speed, use the accelerator
SET” switch (B) when the “CRUISE” indica- pedal to reach your desired speed and then press
tion lamp is illuminated. The vehicle will the “COAST SET” switch (B) and release the
then maintain the desired speed. switch momentarily to set a new desired cruising
speed.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
switch, the vehicle speed will be set. E00609500500
There are 2 ways to decrease the set speed.
To increase the set speed “COAST SET” switch
E00609400570
There are 2 ways to increase the set speed. Press and hold the “COAST SET” switch (B) while
driving at the set speed, and your speed will slow
“ACC RES” switch down gradually.
Press and hold the “ACC RES” switch (C) while
driving at the set speed, and your speed will then
gradually increase.
OCRE12E1 4-51
Starting and driving
When you reach your desired speed, release the Brake pedal To temporarily increase or decrease
switch. Your new cruising speed is now set. While driving at the set speed, use the brake pedal, the speed
which disengages the cruise control, then press the E00619500154
“COAST SET” switch (B) and release the switch
momentarily to set a new desired cruising speed. To temporarily increase the speed
Depress the accelerator pedal as you would normal-
ly. When you release the pedal, you will return to
your set speed.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
(1 mph).
To temporarily decrease the speed
Depress the brake pedal to decrease the speed. To
return to the previously set speed, press the “ACC
RES” switch (C).
Refer to “To resume the set speed” on page 4-53.
4-52 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
CAUTION
l When the set speed driving is deactivated
4
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
automatically in any situation other than Under either of the following conditions, however,
The set speed driving is deactivated automatically those listed above, there may be a system using the switch does not allow you to resume the
in any of the following ways. malfunction. previously set speed. In these situations, repeat the
l When you depress the clutch pedal (on vehi- Press the “ON-OFF” switch to turn off speed setting procedure:
cles with M/T). the cruise control and have it inspected l The “ON OFF” switch is pressed.
l When your speed slows to about 15 km/h by a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Author-
(9 mph) or more below the set speed because ized Service Point. l The ignition switch is turned OFF.
of a hill, etc. l “CRUISE” indication lamp is turned OFF.
l When your speed slows to about 40 km/h
(25 mph) or less.
l When the active stability & traction control
(ASTC) starts operating. (if so equipped)
Refer to “Active Stability & Traction Con-
trol (ASTC)” on page 4-47.
OCRE12E1 4-53
Starting and driving
Cargo loads Trailer towing (Except for Towing bar mounting specifications
See the following table for fixing points (A) for the
E00609901123
vehicles for Morocco) towing bar.
E00610000521
Cargo loads precautions In order to tow a trailer with your vehicle, when hav-
ing a trailer towing device mounted that meets all Club cab
relevant regulations in your area, consult a
CAUTION MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point.
The regulations concerning the towing of a trailer
l When loading luggage, be careful to the
may differ from country to country. You are ad-
following.
• Stow cargo and luggage in the cargo vised to obey the regulations in each area.
area whenever possible.
• Distribute cargo or luggage evenly not
to be unbalanced in weight. CAUTION
• Do not place cargo or luggage on the
instrument panel.
l Danger of Accident!
A towing bar should be fitted according
Also, do not stack up cargo or luggage to MITSUBISHI MOTORS guidelines.
on the front passenger’s seat or the
rear seat.
4 Having the driver’s vision blocked,
and your cargo being thrown inside
NOTE
l If you are going to tow a trailer, pay careful
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the cabin if you suddenly have to attention to the following points.
brake can cause a serious accident or
injury. Maximum towable weight with brake
and maximum trailer-nose weight
Never exceed the maximum towable weight with
brake and the maximum trailer-nose weight as lis-
ted in the specifications. (Refer to “Vehicle
weight” on page 9-10.)
If you tow a trailer at an altitude of more than
1,000 m above sea-level, reduce your weight by
10 % of the gross combination weight for every in-
crease of 1,000 m above sea-level, as the engine out-
put is lowered owing to decrease in atmospheric
pressure.
4-54 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1 4-55
Starting and driving
Club cab Single cab, Double cab (Vehicles without long bed) Double cab (Vehicles with long bed)
1 30 mm 30 mm 30 mm
2 55 mm 55 mm 55 mm
3 115 mm 60 mm 60 mm
4 872 mm 812 mm 812 mm
5 20 mm 20 mm 20 mm
6 85 mm 85 mm 85 mm
7 686 - 699 mm 681 - 689 mm, 580 - 583 mm* 681 - 683 mm, 578 mm*
8 642 - 654 mm 639 - 647 mm, 538 - 541 mm* 639 - 641 mm, 536 mm*
9 612 - 624 mm 609 - 617 mm, 508 - 511 mm* 609 - 611 mm, 506 mm*
10 406 - 419 mm 400 - 409 mm, 292 - 297 mm* 395 - 415 mm, 305 mm*
11 485 - 500 mm 479 - 489 mm, 486 - 491 mm* 475 - 494 mm, 489 mm*
12 897 mm 897 mm 897 mm
4 13 1,251 mm 1,136 mm 1,316 mm
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
14 70 mm 70 mm 70 mm
15 502.5 mm 502.5 mm 502.5 mm
16 540.5 mm 540.5 mm 540.5 mm
4-56 OCRE12E1
Starting and driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1 4-57
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Handling of compact discs...........................................................5-48
Antenna.........................................................................................5-50
Link System*................................................................................5-51
5
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface*.............................................................5-51
USB input terminal*.....................................................................5-67
Sun visors.....................................................................................5-69
Vanity mirror*..............................................................................5-70
Ashtray..........................................................................................5-70
Cigarette lighter............................................................................5-71
Accessory socket*........................................................................5-72
Digital clock*...............................................................................5-73
Interior lamps................................................................................5-73
Storage spaces...............................................................................5-75
Cup holder*..................................................................................5-78
Bottle holder.................................................................................5-79
OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Ventilators Side ventilators These symbols are used in the next several illustra-
tions to demonstrate the quantity of air coming
E00700100344 The ventilator can be opened and closed with the di-
al (B). from the ventilators.
: Small amount of air from the ventilators
- Open : Medium amount of air from the ventilators
( )
: Large amount of air from the ventilators
- Close
( )
Face position
Adjust the direction of the air flow by moving the Air flows only to the upper part of the passenger
knob (C). compartment.
LHD RHD
1- Centre ventilators
2- Side ventilators
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Centre ventilators
5-02 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
“ ” and “ ” positions, air flows mainly to “ ” and “ ” positions, air flows mainly to The heater/air conditioning can only be used while
the upper part of the passenger compartment. the leg area. With the mode selection dial be- the engine is running.
With the mode selection dial between the tween the “ ” and “ ” positions, air
“ ” and “ ” positions, air flows mainly to flows mainly to the windscreen and door win-
Control panel
E00700600512
the leg area. dows.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
RHD
: Optional equipment
5
Foot/Demister position
Air flows to the leg area, the windscreen and the
door windows.
OCRE12E1 5-03
For pleasant driving
Blower speed selection dial NOTE Air is recirculated inside the passenger com-
E00700700119
l While the engine coolant temperature is low, partment.
Select the blower speed by turning the blower
the temperature of the air from the heater
speed selection dial clockwise or anticlockwise.
will be cool/cold until the engine warms up, LHD
The blower speed will gradually increase as the di-
even if you have selected warm air with the
al is turned to the right.
dial.
When the blower speed selection dial is set to the
“OFF” position, all fan-driven airflow will stop.
Mode selection dial
E00701100266
To change the position and amount of air flowing
from the ventilators, turn the mode selection dial.
(Refer to “Changing the mode selection” on page
5-02.)
RHD
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Temperature control dial
5 E00700900209
Turn the temperature control dial clockwise to
make the air warmer. Turn it anticlockwise to
make the air cooler.
Air selection lever
E00701300460
To change the air selection, use the air selection lev-
er.
l “ ” Outside air
Outside air is introduced into the passenger
compartment.
l “ ” Recirculated air
5-04 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
sor will turn on. The air conditioning indication on/off automatically. While the vehicle
lamp (A) will come on. with an A/T is stationary, fully depress
the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle
5
LHD from creeping.
Heating NOTE
Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” position l For maximum heat, set the blower speed at
and set the air selection lever to the “ ” (outside) the 3rd position.
position.
OCRE12E1 5-05
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
LHD CAUTION
5 l For safety, make sure you have a clear
view through all the windows.
5-06 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
LHD
1. Set the air selection lever to the “ ” (out- 1. Set the air selection lever to the “ ” (out-
side) position. side) position.
2. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” posi- 2. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” posi-
tion. tion.
3. Select your desired blower speed by turning 3. Set the blower to the maximum speed.
the blower speed selection dial. 4. Set the temperature to the maximum temper-
4. Select your desired temperature by turning ature position.
the temperature control dial. 5. Push the air conditioning switch (B).
5. Push the air conditioning switch (B). (vehicles with air conditioning)
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
(vehicles with air conditioning)
For quick demisting NOTE
l To demist effectively, direct the air flow 5
from the side ventilators towards the door win-
LHD dows.
l Do not set the temperature control dial to the
max. cool position. Cool air will blow
against the window glasses and form mist on
them.
OCRE12E1 5-07
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Type 2 E00702800273
Select the blower speed by turning the blower
5 RHD
speed selection dial clockwise or anticlockwise.
The blower speed will gradually increase as the di-
al is turned to the right.
5-08 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
When the blower speed selection dial is set to the Temperature control dial NOTE
“OFF” position, all fan-driven airflow will stop. E00703000575
l While the engine coolant temperature is low,
Turn the temperature control dial clockwise to
the temperature of the air from the heater
make the air warmer. Turn it anticlockwise to
will be cool/cold until the engine warms up,
make the air cooler.
even if you have selected warm air with the
dial.
Type 1
Mode selection dial
E00703200274
To change the position and amount of air flowing
from the ventilators, turn the mode selection dial.
(Refer to “Changing the mode selection” on page
5-02.)
Type 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
OCRE12E1 5-09
For pleasant driving
l Recirculated air {Indication lamp (A) is ON} Air conditioning switch Operating the system in automatic
Air is recirculated inside the passenger com- E00703501128
mode
partment. Push the switch, and the air conditioning compres- E00704100919
sor will turn on. The air conditioning indication
lamp (A) will come on.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
and quickly remove fog or frost from the 2. Select the temperature control dial to the de-
5 windscreen.
If high cooling performance is desired, or
CAUTION sired temperature. The temperature can be
set within a range of 17 to 27 (Type 1) or 20
to 30 (Type 2). The temperature will gradual-
if the outside air is dusty or otherwise con- l When using the air conditioning, the
ly increase as the dial is turned to the right.
taminated use the recirculation position. idling speed may slightly increase as the
Switch to the outside position periodically air conditioning compressor is switched 3. Set the mode selection dial to the “AUTO”
to increase ventilation so that the win- on/off automatically. While the vehicle position.
dows do not become fogged up. with an A/T is stationary, fully depress 4. Push the air conditioning switch to operate
the air conditioning. When the air condition-
l Use of the recirculation position for exten- the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle
ing operates, the indication lamp (A) in the di-
ded time may cause the windows to fog up. from creeping.
al will come on.
5-10 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
NOTE To remove frost or mist from the windscreen and For quick demisting
l Set the temperature at about 22 (Type 1) or door windows, use the mode selection dial (“ ”
25 (Type 2) under normal conditions. or “ ”).
l When the temperature is set to the highest or For ordinary demisting
the lowest setting under the AUTO opera-
tion, the air selection, mode selection, blower Use this setting to keep the windscreen and door
speed and the air conditioning will be auto- windows clear of mist, and to keep the leg area heat-
matically changed as follows. ed (when driving in rain or snow).
Also, if manually operated after an automatic
changeover, manual operation will be selec-
ted.
• Quick Heating (When the temperature is
set to the highest setting)
Outside air will be introduced, the air
flow will select foot position, and the air 1. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” posi-
conditioning will stop. tion.
• Quick Cooling (When the temperature is 2. Set the blower to the maximum speed.
set to the lowest setting) 3. Set the temperature to the highest position.
Inside air will be recirculated, the air
flow will select face position, and the air NOTE
conditioning will operate. l While the mode selection dial is set to the
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. Set the air selection switch (A) to the outside
position. “ ” position, the air conditioning will oper-
Operating the system in manual mode
E00704200040
2. Set the mode selection dial to the “ ” posi- ate automatically and the outside air position
will also be selected automatically.
5
tion.
Blower speed and ventilator mode may be control- 3. Select your desired blower speed by turning l To demist effectively, direct the air flow
led manually by setting the blower speed selection the blower speed selection dial. from the side ventilators towards the door win-
dial and the mode selection dial to the desired posi- 4. Select your desired temperature by turning dows.
tions. To return to automatic operation, set the dials the temperature control dial. l Do not set the temperature control dial to the
to the “AUTO” position. 5. Push the air conditioning switch (B). max. cool position. Cool air will blow
against the window glasses and form mist on
Demisting of the windscreen and door windows
E00704300689 them.
CAUTION
l For safety, make sure you have a clear
view through all the windows.
OCRE12E1 5-11
For pleasant driving
Important operation tips for the It is recommended that the refrigerant be recovered
and recycled for further use.
Air purifier*
air conditioning E00708400675
An air filter has been incorporated into this air con-
E00708300951
During a long period of disuse ditioning so that dirt and dust are cleaned from the
l Park the vehicle in the shade. The air conditioning should be operated for at least air.
Parking in the hot sun will make the vehicle
five minutes each week, even in cold weather. This Replace the air filter periodically as its ability to
inside extremely hot, and it will require more
is to prevent poor lubrication of the compressor in- clean the air will be reduced as it collects pollen
time to cool the interior.
ternal parts and to maintain the air conditioning in and dirt. For the maintenance interval, refer to the
If it is necessary to park in the sun, open the
the best operating condition. “SERVICE BOOKLET”.
windows for the first few minutes of air con-
ditioning operation to expel the hot air.
l Close the windows when the air conditioning NOTE
is in use. The entry of outside air through l Operation in certain conditions such as driv-
open windows will reduce the cooling effi- ing on a dusty road and frequent use of the
ciency. air conditioning can lead to reduction of serv-
l Too much cooling is not good for the health. ice life of the filter. When you feel that the
The inside air temperature should only be 5 air flow is lower than normal or when the
to 6 °C below the outside air temperature. windscreen or windows start to fog up easily,
l When operating the system, make sure the replace the air filter.
air intake, which is located in front of the We recommend you to have it checked.
windscreen, is free of obstructions such as
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
leaves and snow. Leaves collected in the air-
intake plenum may reduce air flow and plug
5 the plenum water drains.
5-12 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
A- Display window B- Audio system
5
NOTE
l To listen to the audio system while the engine is stopped, turn the ignition key to the “ACC” position.
l If a cellular phone is used inside the vehicle, it may create noise from the audio equipment. This does not mean that anything is wrong with your audio
equipment. In such a case, use the cellular phone at a place as far away as possible from the audio equipment.
l If foreign objects or water get into the audio equipment, or if smoke or a strange odour comes from it, immediately turn off the audio system. We recom-
mend your to have it checked. Never try to repair it by yourself. Avoid continuous usage without inspection by a qualified person.
l The audio system’s control knob can be removed to deter thieves. For details, refer to “Audio system anti-theft feature” on page 5-48.
l The audio amplifier (if so equipped) is located under the front right seat.
Do not subject the amplifier to a strong impact.
It could damage the amplifier or malfunctioning could result.
OCRE12E1 5-13
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- PWR (On-Off) switch 4- Audio adjust button
2- VOL (Volume control) knob 5- Display
5 3- (Mode change) button
5-14 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
To adjust the volume TREBLE (Treble tone control) SCV (Speed Compensated Volume) function
E00708700665 Press the audio adjust button (4) either or to The Speed Compensated Volume function is a fea-
select the desired treble level. ture that automatically adjusts the VOL, BASS,
VOL (Volume control) MID, and TREBLE settings in accordance with the
Turn the VOL knob (2) clockwise to increase the FADER (Front/Rear balance control) vehicle speed.
volume; Press the audio adjust button (4) either or to The effects of the SCV function can be selected ei-
anticlockwise to decrease the volume. The status balance the volume of sound from the front and the ther of three levels (LOW, MID and HIGH). Select
will be displayed in the display (5). rear speakers. the degree of your choice by pressing the audio ad-
just button (4) either or . If you want to stop
To adjust the tone the SCV function, select the OFF.
E00708801269 BALANCE (Left/Right balance control)
Press the button (3) to select BASS TRE- Press the audio adjust button (4) either or to
BLE FADER BALANCE SCV Audio balance the volume of sound from the left and the NOTE
adjust mode off. The status will be displayed in the right speakers. l Audio adjust mode will be cancelled when an-
display (5). other mode is selected or no adjustment is per-
formed for more than 10 seconds.
BASS (Bass tone control)
Press the audio adjust button (4) either or to
select the desired bass level.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
OCRE12E1 5-15
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- PWR (On-Off) switch 6- FM/MW/LW indicator
2- Memory select buttons 7- Preset memory number display
5 3-
4-
TUNE/SEEK (Up-step/Up-seek) button
TUNE/SEEK (Down-step/Down-seek) button
8-
9-
ST (Stereo) indicator
Frequency display window
5- RADIO (FM/MW/LW selection) button
5-16 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
To listen to the radio To enter frequencies into the memory 3. The preset memory setting is retrieved by
E00709000896 E00716101173 pressing the button and then releasing it with-
1. Press the PWR switch (1) to turn the audio in 2 seconds.
Manual setting
system ON and OFF. The system turns on in
You can assign to the memory select buttons (2) a Automatic setting
the last mode used.
maximum of 18 stations in the FM band (6 FM1, 6 With the method, all manually set stations in the
2. Press the RADIO buttons (5) to select the de-
FM2 and 6 FM3 stations) and 6 stations each in the band currently selected for reception are replaced
sired band.
MW and LW band. (Stations already assigned to with stations in the same band that are automatical-
3. Press the TUNE/SEEK button (3 or 4) to
the memory select buttons are replaced by any new- ly selected in order of signal strength. The radio au-
tune to a station, or press one of the memory
ly assigned stations.) tomatically selects 6 stations in the FM band (FM3
select buttons (2) to recall a station memo-
rised for that button. station only) and 6 stations each in the MW and
LW band.
To tune the radio
E00709100451 Follow the steps described below.
1. With the radio mode selected, hold down the
Automatic tuning RADIO button (5) for 2 seconds or longer.
After keeping the TUNE/SEEK button (3 or 4) de- The 6 stations with the best signal strength
pressed, release the button, and the selected station will automatically be assigned to the memo-
reception will start. ry select buttons (2), with the lowest-frequen-
cy station being assigned to the lowest-num-
Manual tuning
ber button.
The frequency changes every time the TUNE/
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
2. When you subsequently press a memory se-
SEEK button (3 or 4) is pressed. Press the button to lect button to select a channel number, the ra-
select the desired station.
Follow the steps described below.
dio will begin receiving the station assigned 5
to that number.
1. Press either the TUNE/SEEK button (3 or 4)
to tune the frequency to be entered in the mem-
ory. NOTE
2. Press one of the memory select buttons (2) l If you press the RADIO button (5) for 2 sec-
for 2 seconds or longer. onds or longer while tuning in the FM1 or
The number of the button corresponding to FM2 band, the radio will automatically
the entry in the memory and the frequency switch to the FM3 band, where the automatic
are displayed. seeking/storing will be activated.
OCRE12E1 5-17
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- PWR (On-Off) switch 9- RDS (Radio data system) indicator
2- Memory select buttons 10- PTY (Program type) indicator
5 3-
4-
TUNE/SEEK (Down-step/Down-seek) button
TUNE/SEEK (Up-step/Up-seek) button
11-
12-
REG (Regional program) indicator
AF (Alternative Frequencies) indicator
5- RADIO (FM/MW/LW selection) button 13- TP (Traffic program identification) indicator
6- TP (Traffic program) button 14- CT (Clock time) indicator
7- PTY (Program type) button 15- Display
8- MENU button
RDS uses PI (program identification) signal and AF (alternative frequency) list transmitted in addition to the normal FM broadcasting programs, and picks up the
FM stations that are transmitting the same program from the AF list and automatically tunes to the station with the strongest signal intensity.
Therefore, you can continue listening to one program in, for example, a long distance driving without retuning to the other station transmitting the same program
when you are leaving the service area of the currently receiving station.
The RDS radio also features the limited reception of the program types, the break-in reception of the traffic announcement to the EON (enhanced other network)
and emergency broadcast, and the limited/unlimited reception of the regional programs.
5-18 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
AF (Alternative Frequencies) function If there are no frequencies broadcasting the same 19. SOCIAL
E00720900061 programming, the radio searches a frequency broad- 20. RELIGION
The AF function finds a station broadcasting the casting the regional programming. The radio suc- 21. PHONE IN
same program and selects the station with the stron- ceeds in searching the regional programming, then 22. TRAVEL
gest signal of AF lists. the display shows the REG indicator (11). 23. LEISURE
The AF function is turned on (with the AF indica- If the radio does not succeed in searching the re- 24. JAZZ
tor (12) shown on the display) at all times unless gional programming, the radio returns to the recal- 25. COUNTRY
you manually switch it off. led preset station. 26. NATION M (National music)
The PI function can be turned ON and OFF. 27. OLDIES
The AF function can be turned ON and OFF. Refer to “Function setup mode” on page 5-21. 28. FOLK M (Folk music)
Refer to “Function setup mode” on page 5-21. 29. DOCUMENT
CT (Clock Time) function NOTE
E00721000131
l While searching, the audio system is muted. To search for a broadcast of desired program type:
The clock can be set automatically by using the sig- The display shows “WAIT” or “SEARCH”. 1. Press the PTY button (7).
nal from the local RDS stations. Refer to “Adjust- 2. Press the TUNE/SEEK button (3 or 4) for
ing the time” on page 3-12. less than 1 second repeatedly to select your
PTY (Program type)
desired PTY.
REG (Regional) function E00721300349
E00721100057 RDS broadcasts are classified according to pro- 3. Two seconds after a desired PTY has been se-
REG function limits to receive the stations broad- gram type (PTY) as follows. Use the TUNE/SEEK lected, the radio will begin to search for a
casting regional programs. button (3 or 4) to select your desired PTY. broadcast of your selected PTY. During
Regional programming and regional networks are search, the selected PTY on the display blinks.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
organized differently depending on the country or 1. NEWS 4. When the radio picks up a station with your
area (they may be changed according to the hour,
state, or broadcast area), so if you don’t want to re-
2.
3.
AFFAIRS (Current affairs)
INFO (Information)
desired PTY, the display will show the name
of the station.
5
ceive the regional programs automatically, you can 4. SPORT
set up REG ON not to receive regional programs. 5. EDUCATE (Education)
6. DRAMA
The REG function can be turned ON and OFF. 7. CULTURE
Refer to “Function setup mode” on page 5-21. 8. SCIENCE
9. VARIED
PI (Program Identification) search function 10. POP M (Pop music)
E00721200221
When travelling long distance and the recalled pre- 11. ROCK M (Rock music)
set station is weak, the radio searches another fre- 12. EASY M (Easy music)
quency broadcasting the same programming with 13. LIGHT M (Light classics)
the same PI code in AF list. 14. CLASSICS
15. OTHER M (Other music)
16. WEATHER (Weather information)
17. FINANCE
18. CHILDREN
OCRE12E1 5-19
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
pressing the button and then releasing it with- ly at TP stations even if the TUNE/SEEK but-
5 in about 2 seconds. ton (3 or 4) is pressed.
Traffic information
E00721600254
The radio will automatically tune in to traffic infor-
mation broadcasts while receiving FM broadcasts TP (Traffic information Program) search function
E00721800168
or playing compact discs etc. The traffic information program standby function
To select this function, follow the instructions below. is turned on (with the TP indicator (13) shown on
1. Press the TP button (6). The display will the display) and after about 45 seconds since the
show “TP” (13). If the RDS data can be read, RDS indicator (9) turns off due to weak signal or
the display will show “RDS” (9). If not, the the tuning station is changed over from a TP sta-
display will show “NO RDS” for about 5 sec- tion to a station which does not broadcast traffic in-
onds. formation, and seeks out a TP station in all frequen-
cies automatically.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The volume level is set separately for listening to
normal audio programs and for listening to emer-
gency broadcasts. The volume level will therefore 5
change automatically to that set when an emergen-
cy broadcast or traffic information broadcast was
last received. When the emergency broadcast is
over, the radio will return to the previously re-
ceived program and to the corresponding volume
level.
OCRE12E1 5-21
For pleasant driving
2. Press the “MENU” button repeatedly to se- The setting will be shown on the display. NOTE
lect the mode you wish to change. l After selecting a mode, you can leave the func-
The order is: Gracenote Database* AF tion setup mode by taking either of the fol-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
CT REG* TP-S PI-S* PHONE lowing steps:
Function setup mode OFF. • Press the “MENU” button for at least 2
5 seconds.
• Make no entry for 10 seconds.
NOTE
l Although “Gracenote Database” and
“PHONE” appear on the display, these func-
tions is inoperative.
5-22 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- CD eject button 10- (Fast-reverse/Track down) button
2- Disc-loading slot 11- PWR (On-Off) switch 5
3- FOLDER (Folder down) button 12- CD (CD mode changeover) button
4- FOLDER (Folder up) button 13- (Return) button
5- TEXT (Title display) button 14- (Select) button
6- PAGE (Title scroll) button 15- RPT/RDM indicator
7- RPT (Repeat) button 16- Track number indicator
8- RDM (Random) button 17- Track play time indicator
9- (Fast-forward/Track up) button 18- CD indicator
OCRE12E1 5-23
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l An 8 cm compact disc cannot be played on files recorded with certain writing software
5 l
this CD player.
For information concerning the handling of l
or CD recorders (CD-R/RW drivers).
If you record too many folders or files other
compact discs, refer to “Handling of compact than MP3 onto a disc, it may take some time
discs” on page 5-48. before playback starts.
l This unit does not record MP3 files.
To fast-forward/fast-reverse the disc l For information concerning CD-Rs/RWs, re-
fer to “Notes on CD-Rs/RWs” on page 5-49.
Fast-forward 1. Insert a disc containing MP3 files into the slot.
You can fast-forward the disc by pressing the 2. The display shows the folder number and the
button (9). While the button is kept pressed, the
disc will be fast-forwarded.
file number, then playback will begin. CAUTION
Fast-reverse
l Attempting to play a file not in the MP3
format which has a “.mp3” file name may
You can fast-reverse the disc by pressing the but- produce noise from the speakers and
ton (10). While the button is kept pressed, the disc speaker damage, and can damage your
will be fast-reversed. hearing.
5-24 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE
Folder selection The selected folder or file is shown in the display.
l With a disc that contains both CD-DA and
In the order but-
: To start this mode or cancel the se- MP3 files, the repeat mode causes only files 5
lection. of the same format (CD-DA only or MP3
ton (14) files only) to be repeated.
but- : To show the folder or file.
File selection To play tracks in random order
ton (9)
In the order or Random playback for a disc (music CDs only)
button Press the RDM button (8) briefly. “RDM” will ap-
(10) pear on the display. Tracks on the currently selec-
ted disc will be played in a random sequence.
but- : To select the folder or file. To exit the random mode, press the RDM button
To select a desired folder (MP3 CDs only)
ton (15) again.
Folder up Random playback for a folder (MP3 CDs only)
Press the FOLDER button (4) until the desired fold- Press the RDM button (8) briefly. “F-RDM” will ap-
er number appears on the display. pear on the display. Files on the currently selected
folder will be played in a random sequence.
OCRE12E1 5-25
For pleasant driving
To exit the random mode, press the RDM button CD text MP3 title
again. The CD player can display disc and track titles for The CD player can display folder and file titles for
discs encoded with disc and track title information. discs encoded with folder and file information.
Random playback for all folders on a disc (MP3 Press the TEXT button (5) repeatedly to make se- Press the TEXT button (5) for less than 1 second re-
CDs only) peatedly to make selections in the following se-
lections in the following sequence: disc name
Press the RDM button (8) for 1 second or longer quence: folder name file name normal dis-
track name normal display mode.
(until you hear a beep). “RDM” will appear on the play mode.
display. Files from all the folders on the currently
selected disc will be played in a random sequence. Example
To exit the random mode, briefly press the RDM Example
button again. Disc
name Folder
name
NOTE
l With a disc that contains both CD-DA and
MP3 files, the random mode causes only
files of the same format (CD-DA only or Track
MP3 files only) to be played in a random se- name File
name
quence.
To eject a disc
When the CD eject button (1) is pressed, the disc NOTE ID3 tag information
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
automatically stops and is ejected. l The display can show up to 16 characters. If The CD player can display ID3 tag information for
5 NOTE
a disc name or track name has more than 16
characters, press the PAGE button (6) to
files that have been recorded with ID3 tag informa-
tion.
view the next 16 characters. 1. Press the TEXT button (5) for 2 seconds or
l If you do not remove the disc before
15 seconds have elapsed, the CD player will l When there is no title information to be dis- longer to switch to the ID3 tag information.
automatically reload the disc and stop. played, the display shows “NO TITLE”. 2. Then press the TEXT button for less than 1
l Characters that the CD player cannot display second repeatedly to make selections in the
are shown as “ ”. following sequence: album name title
CD text and MP3 title display
E00725000676 name artist name normal display mode.
This CD player can display CD text and MP3 titles
including ID3 tag information. NOTE
l To return from ID3 tag information to the
folder name, press the TEXT button (5)
again for 2 seconds or longer.
l When there is no title information to be dis-
played, the display shows “NO TITLE”.
5-26 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE
l The protected file by copyright might not be
able to start playback. 5
l It is recommended to adjust the equalizer of
the connected device is flat.
OCRE12E1 5-27
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- PWR (On-Off) button 9- (Fast-reverse/Track down) button
2- FOLDER (Folder down) button 10- RADIO button
5 3-
4-
FOLDER (Folder up) button
TEXT button
11- CD (Mode change) button
12- (Return) button
5- PAGE (Title scroll) button 13- (Select) button
6- RPT (Repeat) button 14- iPod indicator
7- RDM (Random) button 15- TRACK indicator
8- (Fast-forward/Track up) button 16- RPT/SHUFFLE/A-SHUFFLE indicator
5-28 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4. Once the device is selected, playback starts Press the RPT button (6) during playback to show
and “iPod” appears on the display. “RPT” in the display.
NOTE To exit this mode, press the button again. 5
NOTE l Pressing the button (9) once during the To play tracks in random order
l Depending on the condition of your iPod, it song will cause the audio system to restart E00756900091
may take a longer time before the playback playback from the beginning of the song. Press the RDM button (7) to show “SHUFFLE” in
starts. the display.The iPod randomly selects tracks from
To find a track from the iPod menu the current category and plays the selected tracks.
5. To stop the playback, change over to a differ- E00756600186 To exit this mode, press the button again.
ent mode. You can select desired tracks from the “Playlists”,
“Artists”,“Albums”, “Songs” or “Genre” (vehicles To play tracks in each album in random order
E00757000099
NOTE with Bluetooth® 2.0 interface) menus on your iPod. Press and hold the RDM button (7) until you hear a
l Buttons on the iPod are disabled while the beep to show “A-SHUFFLE” in the display.
Press the following buttons to select desired tracks. The iPod randomly selects tracks in the album
iPod is connected to the audio system.
The selected menu or category or track is shown in from the current category and play the selected
l To adjust the volume and tone, refer to “To
the display.
adjust the volume” and “To adjust the tone”. tracks.
To exit this mode, press the button again.
OCRE12E1 5-29
For pleasant driving
To switch the display To play iPod tracks via voice opera- NOTE
E00757100090
The display changes as follows every time the tion (vehicles with Bluetooth® 2.0 inter- l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz-
ing the connected device.
TEXT button (4) is pressed during playback. face) If the connected device cannot be recognized
Album title → Track name → Artist name → E00757200046
Desired tracks can be selected and played from or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth®
Genre (vehicles with Bluetooth® 2.0 interface) → 2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice
Normal display your iPod by “Artist”, “Album”, “Playlist” and
“Genre” using voice commands. guide. Follow the voice guide.
For information concerning the voice recognition
Example function or speaker enrollment function, refer to 2. After the voice guide says “Would you like
“Bluetooth® 2.0 interface” on page 5-51. to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or
The following explains how to prepare for voice op- Genre?,” say “Artist”.
eration and play the tracks.
Album title Preparation for voice operation
NOTE
E00757300135 l If you say “Artist <name>,” you can skip
To use the voice operation, press the SPEECH but- step 3.
ton (1) first.
3. After the voice guide says “What Artist
would you like to play?,” say the artist name.
4. If there is only one match, the system pro-
ceeds to step 6.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE 5. If there are two or more matches, the voice
5-30 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
6. After the voice guide says “Playing <artist 4. If there is only one match, the system pro- NOTE
name>,” the system creates a playlist index ceeds to step 6. l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz-
for the artist. 5. If there are two or more matches, the voice ing the connected device.
guide will say “More than one match was If the connected device cannot be recognized
NOTE found, would you like to play <album ti- or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth®
tle>?” If you say “Yes,” the system proceeds 2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice
l If the confirmation function is active, the
to step 6.
voice guide confirms if the artist name is cor- guide. Follow the voice guide.
rect. If the artist name is correct, say “Yes”. If you say “No,” the next matching album is
If not, say “No”. After the voice guide says uttered by the system.
2. After the voice guide says “Would you like
“Artist not found, please try again,” the sys- to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or
tem returns to step 2. NOTE Genre?,” say “Playlist”.
l If you say “No” to three or all album titles ut-
7. The system exits the voice recognition mode tered by the system, the voice guide will say
“Album not found, please try again” and the
NOTE
and starts playback. l If you say “Playlist <playlist>,” you can skip
system returns to step 2.
step 3.
To search by album title If the device has no playlist, the voice guide
E00757500010 6. After the voice guide says “Playing <album will say “There are no playlists stored on de-
1. Say “Play” on the main menu. title>,” the system creates a playlist index for vice” and the system returns to step 2.
the album title.
NOTE 3. After the voice guide says “What Playlist
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz- NOTE would you like to play?,” say the playlist
ing the connected device. l If the confirmation function is active, the name.
If the connected device cannot be recognized voice guide confirms if the album title is cor- 4. If there is only one match, the system pro- 5
or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth® rect. If the album title is correct, say “Yes”. ceeds to step 6.
2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice If not, say “No”. After the voice guide says 5. If there are two or more matches, the voice
guide. Follow the voice guide. “Album not found, please try again,” the sys- guide will say “More than one match was
tem returns to step 2. found, would you like to play <playlist>?” If
2. After the voice guide says “Would you like you say “Yes,” the system proceeds to step 6.
to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or 7. The system exits the voice recognition mode If you say “No,” the next matching playlist
Genre?,” say “Album”. and starts playback. name is uttered by the system.
OCRE12E1 5-31
For pleasant driving
6. After the voice guide says “Playing <play- 3. After the voice guide says “What Genre
list>,” the system creates an index for the play- would you like to play?,” say the music type.
list. 4. If there is only one match, the system pro-
ceeds to step 6.
NOTE 5. If there are two or more matches, the voice
guide will say “More than one match was
l If the confirmation function is active, the
found, would you like to play <genre>?” If
voice guide confirms if the playlist name is
correct. If the playlist name is correct, say you say “Yes,” the system proceeds to step 6.
“Yes”. If not, say “No”. After the voice If you say “No,” the next matching genre is
guide says “Playlist not found, please try uttered by the system.
again,” the system returns to step 2. Refer to
“Confirmation function setting” on page NOTE
5-53. l If you say “No” to three or all genres uttered
by the system, the voice guide will say
7. The system exits the voice recognition mode “Genre not found, please try again” and the
and starts playback. system returns to step 2.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
NOTE NOTE
5 l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface starts recogniz- l If the confirmation function is active, the
ing the connected device. voice guide confirms if the genre is correct.
If the connected device cannot be recognized If the genre is correct, say “Yes”. If not, say
or a connection error occurs, the Bluetooth® “No”. After the voice guide says “Genre not
2.0 interface starts an appropriate voice found, please try again,” the system returns
guide. Follow the voice guide. to step 2. Refer to “Confirmation function set-
ting” on page 5-53.
2. After the voice guide says “Would you like
to play by Artist, Album, Playlist or 7. The system exits the voice recognition mode
Genre?,” say “Genre”. and starts playback.
NOTE
l If you say “Genre <type>,” you can skip step
3.
5-32 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- PWR (On-Off) button 10- RADIO button
2- FOLDER (Folder down) button 11- CD (Mode change) button
3-
4-
FOLDER (Folder up) button
TEXT button
12- (Return) button 5
13- (Select) button
5- PAGE (Title scroll) button 14- USB indicator
6- RPT (Repeat) button 15- FOLDER indicator
7- RDM (Random) button 16- FILE indicator
8- (Fast-forward/File up) button 17- RPT/F-RPT/F-RDM/RDM/SCAN/F-SCAN indicator
9- (Fast-reverse/File down) button
OCRE12E1 5-33
For pleasant driving
To play from a USB memory device Supported compressed music files NOTE
E00758300305
E00762500366
1. Press the PWR button (1) to turn on the au- This audio can play MP3, WMA, AAC and WAV l If a file protected by copyrights is played, the
file will be skipped.
dio system. The system turns on in the last files recorded in a USB memory device. This audio
mode used. supports up to 65,535 files in 700 folders on 8 levels.
2. Connect your USB memory device to the To fast-forward/reverse the track
Folder selection order/file playback order (exam- E00758400090
USB input terminal.
Refer to “How to connect a USB memory de- ple) Fast-forward
vice” on page 5-67. The folder and file hierarchy in the USB memory
To fast-forward the current track, press the but-
3. Press the CD button (11) several times to device is shown below.
ton (8). While the button is pressed, the track will
switch to the USB mode. The mode changes be fast-forwarded.
as follows every time the CD button is pressed.
CD mode → USB mode → Bluetooth® mode* Fast-reverse
Root folder (Root directory)
To fast-reverse the current track, press the but-
ton (9). While the button is pressed, the track will
NOTE
be fast-reversed.
l If your vehicle is equipped with Auxiliary Au-
dio connector (RCA), pressing and holding
To select a file
the CD button for 2 seconds or more E00758500088
switches the system to the AUX mode.
File up
Press the button (8) repeatedly until the desired
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4. Once the device is selected, playback starts
and “USB” appears on the display. file number appears on the display.
5 File down
NOTE Press the button (9) repeatedly until the desired
l Depending on the condition of your USB de- file number appears on the display.
vice, it may take a longer time before the play- Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4
back starts.
NOTE
5. To stop the playback, change over to a differ- Folder selection l Pressing the button (9) once during the
ent mode. song will cause the audio system to restart
In the order playback from the beginning of the song.
NOTE
To find a file
l To adjust the volume and tone, refer to “To E00758600311
adjust the volume” and “To adjust the tone”. File selection You can select a folder to find a desired track.
In the order
Press the following buttons to select desired folder
or file.
The selected folder or file is shown in the display.
5-34 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
To start this mode or cancel To play all folders in random order NOTE
button (12) : E00759000093
the selection.
Press and hold the RDM button (7) until you hear a l Press and hold the TEXT button (4) again un-
til you hear a beep, and the tag information
button (8) : To show the folder or file. beep to show “RDM” in the display.
display returns to the folder title display.
The audio randomly selects files from all folders
or button (9) and plays the selected files. l Up to 16 characters are shown in the display
at once. If the title is cut off in the middle,
: To select the folder or file. To exit this mode, press the button again.
button (13) press the PAGE button (5). The next charac-
To switch the display ters are displayed every time this button is
E00759300155 pressed.
NOTE The display changes as follows every time the l If no title is stored, “NO TITLE” is shown in
l If no operation is performed for 10 seconds TEXT button (4) is pressed during playback. the display.
or more or another button is operated after Folder title → File title → Normal display l Characters that cannot be displayed are sub-
the button or button has been pressed, stituted by “ ”.
searching of the desired file is cancelled. ID3 tag information
l If no operation is performed for 5 seconds or 1. Press and hold the TEXT button (4) until you
more after the file is displayed, playback hear a beep to show “TAG” in the display. To play USB memory device tracks
starts. 2. The display changes as follows every time via voice operation (vehicles with Blue-
the TEXT button (4) is pressed briefly. tooth® 2.0 interface)
Album title → Track title → Artist name →
To play the same file repeatedly E00759400130
E00758700093 Genre (vehicles with Bluetooth® 2.0 inter- Desired tracks can be selected and played from
Press the RPT button (6) to show “RPT” in the dis- face) → Normal display your USB memory device by “Artist”, “Album”,
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
play. “Playlist” and “Genre” using voice commands.
To exit this mode, press the button again. For information concerning the voice recognition
To play the files in the same folder repeatedly
Example
function or speaker enrollment function, refer to 5
E00758800094
“Bluetooth® 2.0 interface” on page 5-51.
Press and hold the RPT button (6) until you hear a
beep to show “F-RPT” in the display. The playback sequence of tracks is the same as
All files in the current folder are played repeatedly. File title when an iPod is connected. Refer to the “To play
To exit this mode, press the button again. iPod tracks via voice operation” on page 5-30.
OCRE12E1 5-35
For pleasant driving
NOTE
l According to the connected device, it is not
to operate correctly or the limitation might
be provided in available function.
l The protected file by copyright might not be
able to start playback.
l It is recommended to adjust the equalizer of
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the connected device is flat.
l
5 The voice operation is not available to access
music files on the connected Bluetooth® de-
vice.
5-36 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- PWR (On-Off) button 8- CD (Mode change) button
2- TEXT (Title display) button 9- (Stop/Pause) button
3- PAGE (Title scroll) button 10- (Play) button 5
4- RPT (Repeat) button 11- BT-A (Bluetooth®) indicator
5- RDM (Random) button 12- TRACK indicator
6- (Fast-forward/File up) button 13- 1-RPT/A-RPT/RDM/SCAN indicator
7- (Fast-reverse/File down) button
OCRE12E1 5-37
For pleasant driving
To listen to tracks from a device con- To pause the playback (if supported by the device) The mode changes as follows every time the RPT
E00762900083 button is pressed.
nected via Bluetooth® To pause the playback, press the button (9). 1-RPT mode → A-RPT mode → mode off
E00762700225
1. Press the PWR button (1) to turn on the au- To restart the playback, press the button (10).
dio system. The system turns on in the last To exit these mode, press the RPT button several
To fast-forward/reverse the track (if supported by times until the 1-RPT indicator or the A-RPT indi-
mode used.
the device) cator goes off.
2. Press the CD button (8) several times to E00765600010
switch to the BT-A (Bluetooth®) mode. The To play tracks in random order (if supported by
mode changes as follows every time the CD Fast-forward
the device)
button is pressed. To fast-forward the current track, press the but- E00763200070
CD mode → USB (iPod) mode → Blue- ton (6). While the button is pressed, the track will Press the RDM button (5) to show “RDM” in the
tooth® mode be fast-forwarded. display.
The system randomly selects and plays tracks from
Fast-reverse
NOTE all tracks in the Bluetooth® device.
To fast-reverse the current track, press the but-
l For vehicles equipped with Auxiliary Audio To exit this mode, press the button again.
ton (7). While the button is pressed, the track will
connector (RCA), pressing and holding the be fast-reversed. To switch the display (if supported by the device)
CD button for 2 seconds or more switches E00763400072
the system to the AUX mode. To select a track (if supported by the device) The display changes as follows every time the
E00763000094
TEXT button (2) is pressed briefly.
3. Connect your Bluetooth® device. Track up Album title → Title name → Artist name → Genre
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Refer to “Connecting the Bluetooth® 2.0 in- Press the button (6) repeatedly until the desired → Normal display
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Auxiliary Video connector (RCA)
A- Left audio input connector (white)
1. Use a commercially available audio cable to
5
B- Right audio input connector (red)
C- Video input connector (yellow) connect the audio equipment to the external
audio input connector.
2. Press the CD button (D) for more than 2 sec-
onds. The display (E) will show “AUX” and
You can listen to commercially available audio
then the external audio input mode will be ac-
equipment, such as a portable audio system, from
tivated.
your vehicle’s speakers, by connecting the audio
3. To deactivate the external audio input mode,
equipment to the audio input connectors, which are
press the RADIO button (F) or the CD but-
external input connectors (pin jacks).
ton (D) to switch to another mode.
OCRE12E1 5-39
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
sired mode. (AM/FM or LW/MW/FM)
Otherwise, noise may be produced from the 2- Volume down button
5 l
speakers.
Connect audio equipment when the external
3-
4-
PWR (ON-OFF)/Mode change button
Seek up/Fast-forward/Track up/File up button
Automatic radio tuning
Seek up button - 4/Seek down button - 5
audio input mode is deactivated or lower the 5- Seek down/Fast-reverse/Track down/File After pressing these buttons, the reception of the se-
vehicle’s speaker volume before connecting it. down button lected station will begin.
Noise may be produced from the speakers if
audio equipment is connected after the exter-
nal audio input mode is activated.
NOTE To listen to a CD
l For information on how to connect and oper- l Do not push two or more of the steering
ate the audio equipment, refer to the owner’s wheel remote control switches at the same To fast-forward/fast-reverse the disc
manual for the equipment. time. To fast-forward or fast-reverse the disc, press the
fast-forward button (4) or the fast-reverse button (5).
To turn on the power
Fast-forward button - 4
PWR (ON-OFF) button - 3 You can fast-forward the disc by pressing the fast-
When the power is off, press this button to turn the forward button. While the button is kept pressed,
power on. To turn the power off, press this button the disc will be fast-forwarded.
for 2 seconds or longer.
5-40 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Press the mode change button (3) and select iPod
number appears on the display.
mode.
NOTE
l The track number increases continuously
while the button is pressed.
OCRE12E1 5-41
For pleasant driving
Error codes
E00710101142
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5 If an error code (1) appears in the display, take action in accordance with the table below.
5-42 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
OCRE12E1 5-43
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5 If an error code (1) appears in the display, take action in accordance with the table below.
5-44 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
OCRE12E1 5-45
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5 If an error code (1) appears in the display, take action in accordance with the table below.
5-46 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
OCRE12E1 5-47
For pleasant driving
Audio system anti-theft feature 2. With the key in the “LOCK” position
The lamp (B) will start flashing to deter
Handling of compact discs
E00710200348 E00723000034
To prevent theft of the audio system, the control thieves. l Use only the type of compact discs that have
knob can be removed. Always remove the control the mark shown in the illustration below.
knob when you leave the vehicle. (Playback of CD-R or CD-RW discs may
cause problems.)
Removing the control knob
Slide the release button (A) to the right and remove
the control knob from the audio system.
The anti-theft function operates in two ways depend-
ing on the position of the ignition key.
NOTE
l When sliding the release button, place one
hand on the control knob to prevent it from
falling out.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5 Refitting the control knob
Put the control knob back into the original position
and then push it until it clicks. The “Please refit the
1. With the key in the “ON” or “ACC” posi- control panel.” indicator will disappear or the lamp
tion (B) will stop flashing.
The “Please refit the control panel.” indicator
will appear on the display. Any audio system
NOTE
operation will be disabled while the “Please
refit the control panel.” indicator is displayed. l Do not leave the control knob in any place
where it may become hot (for example, the
dashboard) or in any place where it may be-
come wet.
l If you lose the control knob, contact a
MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service
Point.
5-48 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
l The use of special shaped, damaged compact • When the temperature suddenly rises, l Do not use a ball point pen, felt pen, pencil,
discs (like cracked discs) or low-quality com- such as right after the heater is turned on etc. to write on the label surface of the disc.
pact discs (like warped discs or burrs on the in cold weather. l Do not put additional labels (A) or stickers
discs) such as those shown will damage the (B) on compact discs. Also, do not use any
CD player. In this case, wait until the moisture has compact disc on which a label or sticker has
had time to dry out. started to peel off or any compact disc that
l When the CD player is subjected to violent vi- has stickiness or other contamination left by
brations, such as during off-road driving, the a peeled-off label or sticker. If you use such
tracking may not work. a compact disc, the CD player may stop work-
l When storing compact discs, always store ing properly and you may not be able to eject
them in their separate cases. Never place com- the compact disc.
pact discs in direct sunlight, or in any place
where the temperature or humidity is high.
l Never touch the flat surface of the disc with-
out a label. This will damage the disc surface
and could affect the sound quality. When han-
dling a compact disc, always hold it by the
outer edge and the centre hole.
l To clean a disc, use a soft, clean, dry cloth.
Wipe directly from the centre hole towards
the outer edge. Do not wipe in a circle. Nev-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
er use any chemicals such as benzine, paint
thinner, a disc spray cleaner, or an anti-static
agent on the disc. 5
Notes on CD-Rs/RWs
E00725100039
OCRE12E1 5-49
For pleasant driving
WARNING
l Operating the CD player in a manner oth-
er than specifically instructed herein may
result in hazardous radiation exposure. To remove
Do not remove the cover and attempt to Turn the pole (A) anticlockwise.
repair the CD player by yourself. There
NOTE
l Be sure to retract the pillar antenna in the fol-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
are no user serviceable parts inside. In To install
case of malfunction, we recommend you lowing cases:
Screw the pole (A) clockwise into the base (B) un-
5 to have it checked. • When entering a place with low clearance.
• When using an automatic car wash.
til it is securely retained.
• When placing a car cover over the vehicle.
5-50 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
TOOTH SIG, INC.
tooth® 2.0 interface and Bluetooth® device” on
Link System End User Licence Agree-
ment
page 5-55.
5
E00764600013 Bluetooth®
is a registered trademark of BLUE-
You have acquired a device that includes software TOOTH SIG, INC.
licensed by MITSUBISHI MOTORS CORPORA-
TION from JOHNSON CONTROLS Inc (the auto-
motive experience business unit), and their subse-
quent 3rd party suppliers. For a complete list of
these 3rd party products and their end user licence
agreements, please go to the following website.
http://www.jciblueconnect.com/faq/fulldisclo-
sure.pdf
OCRE12E1 5-51
For pleasant driving
PICK-UP button
NOTE l Press this button when an incoming call is re-
l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot be used ceived to answer the telephone.
if the Bluetooth® device has a flat battery or l When another call is received during a call,
the device power is turned off. press this button to put the first caller on
hold and talk to the new caller.
l Hands-free calls will not be possible if your
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
phone does not have service available. • In such circumstances, you can press the
5 l If you place the Bluetooth® device in the car-
go area, you may not be able to use the Blue-
button briefly to switch between callers.
You will switch to the first caller and the
other caller will be put on hold.
tooth® 2.0 interface. • To establish a three-way call in such sit-
l Some Bluetooth® devices are not compatible 1- Volume up button
uations, press the SPEECH button to en-
with the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. 2- Volume down button
ter voice recognition mode and then say
3- SPEECH button
l For details on the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface,
4- PICK-UP button
“Join calls”.
you can see them by accessing the
MITSUBISHI MOTORS website. 5- HANG-UP button HANG-UP button
Please read and agree on the “Warning about l Press this button when an incoming call is re-
Links to the Web Sites of Other Companies” Volume up button
ceived to refuse the call.
because it connects to other than Press this button to increase the volume.
l Press this button during a call to end the cur-
MITSUBISHI MOTORS website. rent call.
http://www.mitsubishi-motors.com/en/prod- Volume down button
When another call is on hold, you will
ucts/index.html Press this button to decrease the volume. switch to that call.
5-52 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
l If this button is pressed in the voice recogni- NOTE l Changing the language deletes the mobile
tion mode, the voice recognition mode will l If the voice command that you say differs phone book imported to the Bluetooth® 2.0
be deactivated. from the predefined command or cannot be interface. If you wish to use it, you will have
recognised due to ambient noise or some oth- to import it again.
NOTE er reason, the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will
l When you press the SPEECH button to enter ask you for the voice command again up to 3 6. When the voice guide says “English (French,
voice recognition mode with a cellular phone times. Spanish, Italian, German, Dutch, Portuguese
paired to the system, current information on l For best performance and further reduction or Russian) selected,” the language change
the cellular phone, such as “remaining bat- of ambient noise, the vehicle windows process will be completed and the system
tery life,” “signal strength” or “roaming,” should be closed while engaging the voice rec- will return to the main menu.
will be displayed on the audio display.* ognition function.
*: Some cellular phones will not send this in- l Depending on the selected language, some
Useful voice commands
formation to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. functions may not be available. E00760000019
possible to use those services with your cellu- 1. Press the SPEECH button. The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface is equipped with a
lar phone. 2. Say “Setup”. help function. If you say “Help” when the system
3. Say “Language.” is waiting for a voice command input, the system
4. The voice guide will say “Select a language: will tell you a list of the commands that can be
Voice recognition function English, French, Spanish, Italian, German, used under the circumstances.
E00727300471
Dutch, Portuguese or Russian” Say the de-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface is equipped with a sired language. (Example: Say “English.”) Cancelling
voice recognition function.
Simply say voice commands and you can perform
5. The voice guide will say “English (French,
Spanish, Italian, German, Dutch, Portuguese
There are two cancel functions.
E00760200011
5
various operations and make or receive hands-free If you are at the main menu, say “Cancel” to exit
or Russian) selected. Is this correct?” Say
calls. “Yes.” from the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
With the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, voice recogni- Answer “No” to return to Step 4. If you are anywhere else within the system, say
tion is possible for English, French, Spanish, Ital- “Cancel” to return to the main menu.
ian, German, Dutch, Portuguese and Russian. The
factory setting is English. NOTE Confirmation function setting
l The voice guide will repeat the same mes- E00760400013
sage twice. The first message is in the cur- The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface is equipped with a con-
rent language, and the second message is in firmation function.
the selected language. With the confirmation function activated, you are
l If many entries are registered in the vehicle given more opportunities than normal to confirm a
phone book, changing the language will take command when making various settings to the Blue-
longer. tooth® 2.0 interface. This allows you to decrease
the possibility that a setting is accidentally changed.
The confirmation function can be turned on or off
by following the steps below.
OCRE12E1 5-53
For pleasant driving
1. Press the SPEECH button. 6. For confirmation purposes, the voice guide l If you have forgotten your password, say
2. Say “Setup”. will say “Password <4-digit password>. Is “Cancel” to quit the voice input mode and
3. Say “Confirmation prompts”. this correct?” Answer “Yes.” then check with a MITSUBISHI MOTORS
4. The voice guide will say “Confirmation Answer “No” to return to the password input Authorized Service Point.
prompts are <on/off>. Would you like to turn in Step 5.
confirmation prompts <off/on>”. 7. When the registration of the password is com- Disabling the password
Answer “Yes” to change the setting or an- pleted, the voice guide will say “Password is Use the following procedure to turn off the security
swer “No” to keep the current setting. enabled” and the system will return to the function by disabling the password.
5. The voice guide will say “Confirmation main menu.
prompts are <off/on>” and then the system NOTE
will return to the main menu. NOTE l System must be unlocked to disable the pass-
word.
l Password will be required to access the sys-
Security function tem after the next ignition cycle.
E00760500131
l It is required for a little time after engine 1. Press the SPEECH button.
It is possible to use a password as a security func- 2. Say “Setup”.
stop that the entered password is actually re-
tion by setting a password of your choice for the 3. Say “Password.”
corded in the system.
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. If the ignition switch is made to “ACC” or 4. The voice guide will say “Password is ena-
When the security function is turned on, it is neces- “ON” or the engine is started immediately af- bled. Would you like to disable it?”
sary to make a voice input of a 4-digit password in ter engine stop, there is a case when the en- Answer “Yes.” Answer “No” to cancel the
order to use all functions of the Bluetooth® 2.0 in- tered password is not recorded in the system. disabling of the password and return to the
terface, except for reception. At this time, please try to enter the password main menu.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
again. 5. When the disabling of the password is com-
Setting the password
5 Use the following procedure to turn on the security Entering the password
pleted, the voice guide will say “Password is
disabled” and the system will return to the
function by setting a password. If a password has been set and the security function main menu.
1. Press the SPEECH button. is enabled, the voice guide will say “Hands-free sys-
2. Say “Setup”. tem is locked. State the password to continue”
3. Say “Password.” when the SPEECH button is pressed to enter voice Speaker enrollment function
4. The voice guide will say “Password is disa- recognition mode. Say the 4-digit password num-
E00727400209
bled. Would you like to enable it?” Answer The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface can use the speaker en-
ber to enter the password.
“Yes.” rollment function to create a voice model for one
If the entered password is wrong, the voice guide
Answer “No” to cancel the setting of the pass- person per language.
will say “<4- digit password>, Incorrect password.
word and return to the main menu. Please try again”. Enter the correct password. This makes it easier for the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
5. The voice guide will say “Please say a 4-dig- face to recognise voice commands said by you.
it password. Remember this password. It will You can turn a voice model registered with the
be required to use this system”. NOTE speaker enrollment function on and off whenever
Say a 4-digit number which you want to set l You can re-enter the password as many times you want.
as a password. as you want.
5-54 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Speaker enrollment NOTE Enabling and disabling the voice model and re-
E00727500196
It takes about 2 to 3 minutes to complete the speak-
l If you do not start the speaker enrollment proc- training
ess within 3 minutes of pressing the E00727600096
er enrollment process. SPEECH button, the speaker enrollment func- You can turn a voice model registered with the
To ensure the best results, run through the process tion will time out. speaker enrollment function on and off whenever
while in the driver’s seat, in an environment that is The voice guide will say “Speaker Enroll- you want.
as quiet as possible (when there is no rain or strong ment has timed out”. The system will then You can also retrain the system.
winds and the vehicle windows are closed). Please beep and the voice recognition mode will be Use the following procedure to perform these ac-
turn off your phone while in speaker enrollment to deactivated. tions.
prevent interruption of the process. 1. Press the SPEECH button.
Use the following procedure for speaker enrollment. 2. Say “Voice training”.
5. The voice guide will prompt for phrase 1. Re-
1. Stop your vehicle in a safe area, put the gear- 3. If you have completed a speaker enrollment
peat the corresponding phrase listed in table
shift lever in the “N” (Neutral) position process once already, the voice guide will
“Enrollment commands” on page 5-66.
(M/T), or the selector lever in the “P” say either “Enrollment is enabled. Would
The system will register your voice and then
(PARK) position (A/T), and pull the parking you like to disable or retrain?” or “Enroll-
move on to the registration of the next com-
brake lever. ment is disabled. Would you like to enable
mand. Continue the process until all phrases
or retrain?”
have been registered.
NOTE 4. When enrollment is “enabled”, the voice mod-
l Speaker enrollment is not possible unless the el is on; when enrollment is “disabled”, the
vehicle is parked. Make sure you park the ve- NOTE voice model is off. Say the command that
hicle in a safe area before attempting speaker l To repeat the most recent voice training com- fits your needs.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
mand, press and release the SPEECH button. Say “Retrain” to start the speaker enrollment
enrollment.
l If you press the HANG-UP button anytime process and recreate a new voice model. (Re-
2. Press the SPEECH button.
during the process, the system will beep and
stop the speaker enrollment process.
fer to “Speaker enrollment” on page 5-55.) 5
3. Say “Voice training”.
4. The voice guide will say “This operation
6. When all enrollment commands have been Connecting the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
must be performed in a quiet environment
while the vehicle is stopped. See the owner’s
read out, the voice guide will say “Speaker face and Bluetooth® device
enrollment is complete”. The system will E00760600204
manual for the list of required training phra- Before you can make or receive hands-free calls or
then end the speaker enrollment process and
ses. Press and release the SPEECH button play music using the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface func-
return to the main menu.
when you are ready to begin. Press the HANG- tion, you must pair the Bluetooth® device and Blue-
UP button to cancel at any time”.
NOTE tooth® 2.0 interface.
Press the SPEECH button to start the speaker
enrollment process. l Completing the speaker enrollment process
will turn on the voice model automatically.
l The commands “Help” and “Cancel” will not
work in this mode.
OCRE12E1 5-55
For pleasant driving
NOTE 4. Say “Pairing options.” l The pairing code entered here is only used
l Pairing is required only when the device is 5. The voice guide will say “Select one of the for the Bluetooth® connection certification.
used for the first time. Once the device has following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” Say It is any 4-digit number the user would like
been paired with the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter- “Pair.” to select.
face, you only need to bring the device into Remember the pairing code as it needs to be
the vehicle next time and the device will au- NOTE keyed into the Bluetooth® device later in the
tomatically connect to the Bluetooth® 2.0 in- l If 7 devices have already been paired, the pairing process.
terface (if supported by the device). voice guide will say “Maximum devices Depending on the connection settings of the
paired” and then the system will end the pair- Bluetooth® device, this code may have to be
ing process. To register a new device, delete entered each time you connect the Blue-
Up to 7 Bluetooth® devices can be paired with the
one device and then repeat the pairing process. tooth® device to the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. (Refer to “Deleting a device” on page 5-57.) face. For the default connection settings, re-
If multiple paired Bluetooth® devices are available fer to the instructions for the device.
in the vehicle, the cellular phone or music player
6. The voice guide will say “Please say a 4-dig-
most recently connected is automatically connected
it pairing code.” Say a 4-digit number. 7. The voice guide will say “Start pairing proce-
to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. When the confirmation function is on, the sys- dure on the device. See the device manual
tem will confirm whether the number said is for instructions.” Enter in the Bluetooth® de-
You can also change a Bluetooth® device to be con- acceptable. Answer “Yes.”
nected. vice the 4-digit number you have registered
Answer “No” to return to pairing code selec- in Step 6.
tion.
To pair
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
To pair a Bluetooth® device with the Bluetooth® NOTE
NOTE
5 2.0 interface, follow the steps below.
1. Stop your vehicle in a safe area, put the gear- l Some Bluetooth® devices require a specific
l According to the corresponding device to
Bluetooth®, it might take a few minutes to
pairing code. pair the Bluetooth® device with the Blue-
shift lever in the “N” (Neutral) position
Please refer to the device manual for pairing
(M/T), or the selector lever in the “P” tooth® 2.0 interface.
code requirements.
(PARK) position (A/T), and pull the parking l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot recog-
brake lever. nize the Bluetooth® device, the voice guide
will say “Pairing has timed out” and the pair-
NOTE ing process will be cancelled.
l You cannot pair Bluetooth® devices with the Confirm that the device you are pairing sup-
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface unless the vehicle is ports Bluetooth®, and try pairing it again.
parked. Before pairing a Bluetooth® device l If you enter the wrong number, the voice
with the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface, confirm guide will say “Pairing failed” and the pair-
that the vehicle is parked in a safe location. ing process will be cancelled. Confirm the
number is right, and try pairing it again.
2. Press the SPEECH button.
3. Say “Setup”.
5-56 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
8. The voice guide will say “Please say the When the confirmation function is on, the sys- Answer “No,” and the voice guide will say
name of the device after the beep.” You can tem will ask you again whether the phone “Please say.” Say the number of the music
assign a desired name for the Bluetooth® de- that you want to connect to is correct. An- player that you want to connect to.
vice and register it as a device tag. Say the swer “Yes” to continue and connect to the cel-
name you want to register after the beep. lular phone. NOTE
Answer “No,” and the voice guide will say
“Please say.” Say the number of the phone
l You can connect to a music player at any
NOTE time by pressing the SPEECH button and say-
that you want to connect to. ing the number, even before all of the paired
l When the confirmation function is on, after
repeating the device tag you have said, the numbers and device tags of corresponding mu-
voice guide will ask “Is this correct?” An- NOTE sic players are read out by the system.
swer “Yes.” l You can connect to a phone at any time by
To change the device tag, answer “No” and pressing the SPEECH button and saying the 5. The selected music player will be connected
then say the device tag again. number, even before all of the paired num- to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
bers and device tags of corresponding cellu- The voice guide will say “<device tag> selec-
9. The voice guide will say “Pairing complete,” lar phones are read out by the system. ted” and then the system will return to the
after which a beep will be played and the pair- main menu.
ing process will end. 5. The selected phone will be connected to the
Bluetooth® 2.0 interface. The voice guide Deleting a device
will say “<device tag> selected” and then the Use the following procedure to delete a paired Blue-
Selecting a device
E00760700016 system will return to the main menu. tooth® device from the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
1. Press the SPEECH button.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
If multiple paired Bluetooth® devices are available
in the vehicle, the cellular phone or music player To select a music player 2. Say “Setup”.
most recently connected is automatically connected 1. Press the SPEECH button.
2. Say “Setup”.
3. Say “Pairing options.”
4. The voice guide will say “Select one of the
5
to the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
3. Say “Select music player.” following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” Say “De-
You can connect to the other cellular phone or mu-
4. After the voice guide says “Please say,” the lete.”
sic player by following setting change procedures.
numbers of the music players and device tags 5. After the voice guide says “Please say,” the
To select a cellular phone of corresponding music players will be read numbers of the devices and device tags of cor-
1. Press the SPEECH button. out in order, starting with the music player responding devices will be read out in order,
2. Say “Setup”. that has been most recently connected. starting with the device that has been most re-
3. Say “Select phone.” Say the number of the music player that you cently connected. After it completes reading
4. After the voice guide says “Please say,” the want to connect to. all pairs, the voice guide will say “or all.”
numbers of the cellular phones and device When the confirmation function is on, the sys- Say the number of the device that you want
tags of corresponding cellular phones will be tem will ask you again whether the music to delete from the system.
read out in order, starting with the cellular player that you want to connect to is correct. If you want to delete all paired phones from
phone that has been most recently connected. Answer “Yes” to continue and connect to the the system, say “All.”
Say the number of the cellular phone that music player.
you want to connect to.
OCRE12E1 5-57
For pleasant driving
6. For confirmation purposes, the voice guide NOTE please?” Say the number of the device tag
will say “Deleting <device tag> <number>. l If you press and release the SPEECH button you want to change.
Is this correct?” or “Deleting all devices. Is and say “Continue” or “Previous” while the
this correct?” list is being read, the system will advance or NOTE
Answer “Yes” to delete the phone(s). rewind the list.
Answer “No” to return to Step 4.
l You can press and release the SPEECH but-
Say “Continue” to proceed to the device with ton while the list is being read, and immedi-
7. The voice guide will say “Deleted,” and then the next highest number or “Previous” to re- ately say the number of the device tag you
the system will end the device deletion proc- turn to the phone with the previous number. want to change.
ess. l You can change the device tag by pressing
and releasing the SPEECH button and then 6. The voice guide will say “New name,
NOTE saying “Edit” while the list is being read. please.” Say the name you want to register as
l If the device deletion process fails for some l You can change the phone to be connected a new device tag.
reason, the voice guide will say “Delete by pressing and releasing the SPEECH but- When the confirmation function is on, the
failed” and then the system will cancel delet- ton and then saying “Select phone” while the voice guide will say “<New device tag>. Is
ing the device. list is being read. this correct?” Answer “Yes.”
l You can change the music player to be con- Answer “No,” to say the new device tag you
nected by pressing and releasing the want to register again.
To check a paired Bluetooth® device SPEECH button and then saying “Select mu-
E00760800017 7. The device tag is changed.
sic player” while the list is being read. When the change is complete, the voice
You can check a paired Bluetooth® device by fol-
lowing the steps below. guide will say “New name saved” and then
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. Press the SPEECH button. Changing a device tag the system will return to the main menu.
E00760900018
2. Say “Setup”.
5 3. Say “Pairing options.”
4. The voice guide will say “Select one of the
You can change the device tag of a paired cellular
phone or music player. Operating a music player connected
following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” Say
Follow the steps below to change a device tag. via Bluetooth®
1. Press the SPEECH button. E00761000016
“List.” For the operation of a music player connected via
2. Say “Setup”.
5. The voice guide will read out device tags of
3. Say “Pairing options.” Bluetooth®, refer to “To play tracks from a Blue-
corresponding devices in order, starting with
4. The voice guide will say “Select one of the tooth® device” on page 5-36.
the Bluetooth® device that has been connec- following: pair, edit, delete, or list.” Say “Ed-
ted most recently.
6. After the device tags of all paired Bluetooth®
it.” How to make or receive hands-free calls
5. The voice guide will say “Please say,” and E00761100020
devices have been read, the system will say read out the numbers of the Bluetooth® devi- You can make or receive hands-free calls using a
“End of list, would you like to start from the ces and device tags of corresponding devices Bluetooth® compatible cellular phone connected to
beginning?” the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface.
in order, starting with the Bluetooth® that
To hear the list again from the beginning , an- You can also use the phone books in the Blue-
has been most recently connected.
swer “Yes.”
After all paired device tags have been read, tooth® 2.0 interface to make calls without dialling
When you are done, answer “No” to return to
the voice guide will say “Which device, telephone numbers.
the main menu.
5-58 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
“To make a call” on page 5-59 NOTE es, the voice guide will say “More than one
“SEND function” on page 5-60 l In the case of English, the system will recog- match was found, would you like to call <re-
“Receiving calls” on page 5-60 nise both “zero” and “oh” (Letter “o”) for the turned name>.” If that person is the one you
“MUTE function” on page 5-60 number “0.” want to call, answer “Yes.”
“Switching between hands-free mode and private l The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface supports num- Answer “No,” and the name of the next match-
mode” on page 5-60 bers (0 to 9) and characters (+, # and *). ing person will be uttered by the voice guide.
l The maximum supported telephone number
NOTE length is as follows: NOTE
• International telephone number: + and tel- l If you say “No” to all names read by the sys-
l The hands-free calls might not be operated
ephone numbers (to 18 digits).
correctly when it makes calling or receiving tem, the voice guide will say “Name not
by operating the cellular phone directly. • Except for international telephone num- found, returning to main menu” and the sys-
ber: telephone numbers (to 19 digits). tem will return to the main menu.
To make a call Making a call using a phone book
E00761200122
You can make calls using the vehicle phone book 5. If only one telephone number is registered un-
You can make a call in the following 3 ways using der the name you just said, the voice guide
or mobile phone book of the Bluetooth® 2.0 inter-
the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface: face. proceeds to Step 6.
Making a call by saying a telephone number, mak- For details on the phone books, refer to “Phone If two or more telephone numbers are regis-
ing a call using the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface’s book function” on page 5-60. tered that match the name you just said, the
phone book, and making a call by redialing. 1. Press the SPEECH button. voice guide will say “Would you like to call
2. Say “Call.” <name> at [home], [work], [mobile], or [oth-
Making a call by using the telephone number
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
er]?” Select the location to call.
You can make a call by saying the telephone number.
1. Press the SPEECH button.
2. Say “Dial.”
NOTE
l If you say “Call” when the vehicle phone NOTE 5
3. After the voice guide says “Number please,” book and the mobile phone book are empty, l If the name you selected has matching data
the voice guide will say “The vehicle phone in the vehicle phone book but no telephone
say the telephone number. number is registered under the selected loca-
4. The voice guide will say “Dialing <number book is empty. Would you like to add a new
entry now?” tion, the voice guide will say “{home/work/
recognised>.” The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface mobile/other} not found for <name>. Would
will then make the call. Answer “Yes,” and the voice guide will say
“Entering the phone book - new entry you like to add location or try again?”
When the confirmation function is on, the sys- Say “Try again,” and the system will return
tem will confirm again the telephone num- menu.” You can now create data in the vehi-
cle phone book. to Step 3.
ber. To continue with that number, answer Say “Add location” and you can register an
“Yes.” Answer “No,” to return to the main menu.
additional telephone number under the selec-
To change the telephone number, answer ted location.
“No.” The system will say “Number please” 3. After the voice guide says “Name please,”
then say the telephone number again. say the name you want to call, from those reg-
istered in the phone book.
4. If there is only 1 match, the system will pro-
ceed to Step 5. If there are 2 or more match-
OCRE12E1 5-59
For pleasant driving
l If the name you selected has matching data For example, if during a call you need to simulate Switching between hands-free mode and private
in the mobile phone book but no telephone the press of a phone button as a response to an auto- mode
number is registered under the selected loca- mated system, press the SPEECH button and speak E00761400036
tion, the voice guide will say “{home/work/ “1 2 3 4 pound SEND” and the 1234# will be sent The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface can switch between
mobile/other} not found for <name>. Would on your cellular phone. Hands-free mode (Hands-free calls) and private
you like to try again?” mode (calls using cellular phone).
Answer “Yes,” and the system will return to Receiving calls If you press the SPEECH button and say “Transfer
E00761600012
Step 3. call” during a Hands-free call, you can stop the
If an incoming phone call is received while the ig-
Answer “No,” and the call will be cancelled. Hands-free mode and talk in private mode.
nition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” position, the
Start over again from Step 1. To return to Hands-free mode, press the SPEECH
audio system will be automatically turned on and
button again and say “Transfer call”.
switched to the incoming call, even when the audio
6. The voice guide will say “Calling <name> system was originally off.
<location>” and then the system will dial the
Phone book function
The voice guide announcement for the incoming E00763700017
telephone number. call will be output from the front passenger’s seat The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface has 2 types of unique
speaker. phone books that are different from the phone book
NOTE If the CD player or radio was playing when the in- stored in the cellular phone. They are the vehicle
l When the confirmation function is on, the sys- coming call was received, the audio system will phone book and the mobile phone book.
tem will ask if the name and location of the mute the sound from the CD player or radio and out- These phone books are used to register telephone
receiver are correct. put only the incoming call. numbers and to make calls to desired numbers via
If the name is correct, answer “Yes.” To receive the call, press the PICK-UP button on the voice recognition function.
the steering wheel control switch.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
To change the name or location to call, an-
swer “No.” The system will return to Step 3. When the call is over, the audio system will return
NOTE
5 Redialing
to its previous state.
l Disconnecting the battery cable will not de-
You can redial the last number called, based on the MUTE function lete information registered in the phone book.
E00760300041
history of dialed calls in the paired cellular phone.
At any time during a call, you can mute the vehicle
Use the following procedure to redial. Vehicle phone book
microphone.
1. Press the SPEECH button. E00763800177
Pressing the SPEECH button and then saying This phone book is used when making calls with
2. Say “Redial.”
“Mute” during a call will turn ON the MUTE func- the voice recognition function.
tion and mute the microphone. Up to 32 names can be registered in the vehicle
SEND function Saying “Mute off” in the same way will turn off
E00761300035 phone book per language.
the MUTE function and cancel the mute on the mi- Also, each entry has 4 locations associated with:
During a call, press the SPEECH button to enter
crophone. home, work, mobile and other. You can register
voice recognition mode, then say “<numbers>
SEND” to generate DTMF tones. one telephone number for each location.
You can register a desired name as a name for any
phone book entry registered in the vehicle phone
book.
5-60 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
number “0.”
4. The voice guide will say “Name please.” Say tooth®, depending on the compatibility of the
your preferred name to register it.
7. The voice guide will repeat the telephone l
device.
The maximum supported telephone number 5
number you have just read, and then register length is 19 digits. Any telephone number of
NOTE the number.
l If the maximum number of entries are al- 20 digits or more will be truncated to the
When the telephone number has been regis- first 19 digits.
ready registered, the voice guide will say
tered, the voice guide will say “Number l If telephone numbers contain characters oth-
“The phone book is full. Would you like to
saved. Would you like to add another num- er than 0 to 9, *, # or +, these characters are
delete a name?” Say “Yes” if you want to de-
ber for this entry?” deleted before the transfer.
lete a registered name.
To add another telephone number for a new l For the connection settings on the cellular
Say “No,” to return to the main menu.
location for the current entry, answer “Yes.” phone side, refer to the instructions for the
The system will return to location selection cellular phone.
5. When the name has been registered, the in Step 5.
voice guide will say “home, work, mobile, or Answer “No” to end the registration process
other?” Say the location for which you want 1. Press the SPEECH button.
and return to the main menu.
to register a telephone number. 2. Say “Phone book.”
OCRE12E1 5-61
For pleasant driving
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the NOTE 10. The voice guide will say “Would you like to
following: new entry, edit number, edit l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface cannot recog- import another contact?”
name, list names, delete, erase all, or import nise the Bluetooth® compatible cellular Answer “Yes” if you want to continue with
contact.” Say “Import contact.” phone or the connection takes too much the registration. You can continue to register
4. The voice guide will say “Would you like to time, the voice guide will say “Import con- a new phone book entry from Step 5.
import a single entry or all contacts?” Say tact has timed out” and then the system will Answer “No,” to return to the main menu.
“Single entry.” cancel the registration. In such case, start
The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will become over again from Step 1. To change the content registered in the vehicle
ready to receive transferred phone book data. l Pressing the HANG-UP button or pressing phone book
and holding the SPEECH button will cancel You can change or delete a name or telephone num-
NOTE the registration. ber registered in the vehicle phone book.
l If the maximum number of entries are al- You can also listen to the list of names registered
ready registered, the voice guide will say 7. When the reception is complete, the voice in the vehicle phone book.
“The phone book is full. Would you like to guide will say “<Number of telephone num-
delete a name?” Say “Yes” if you want to de- bers that had been registered in the import NOTE
lete a registered name. source> numbers have been imported. What
Say “No,” to return to the main menu.
l The system must have at least one entry.
name would you like to use for these num-
bers?”
5. After the voice guide says “Ready to receive Say the name you want to register for this [Editing a telephone number]
a contact from the phone. Only a home, a phone book entry. 1. Press the SPEECH button.
2. Say “Phone book.”
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
work, and a mobile number can be impor-
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the
ted,” the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will re- NOTE
5 ceive the phone book data from the Blue- l If the entered name is already used for other
following: new entry, edit number, edit
name, list names, delete, erase all, or import
tooth® compatible cellular phone. phone book entry or similar to a name used
contact.” Say “Edit number.”
6. Operate the Bluetooth® compatible cellular for other phone book entry, that name cannot
4. The voice guide will say “Please say the
phone to set it up so that the phone book en- be registered.
name of the entry you would like to edit, or
try you want to register in the vehicle phone say list names.” Say the name of the phone
book can be transferred to the Bluetooth® 2.0 8. The voice guide will say “Adding <name>.” book entry you want to edit.
interface. When the confirmation function is on, the sys-
tem will ask if the name is correct. Answer
NOTE
“Yes.”
Answer “No,” and the voice guide will say l Say “List names,” and the names registered
in the phone book will be read out in order.
“Name please.” Register a different name.
Refer to “Listening to the list of registered
9. The voice guide will say “Numbers saved.”
names” on page 5-60.
5-62 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
5. The voice guide will say “Home, work, mo- 2. Say “Phone book.” 5. When the voice guide is done reading the
bile or other?” Select and say the location 3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the list, it will say “End of list, would you like to
where the telephone number you want to following: new entry, edit number, edit start from the beginning?”
change or add is registered. name, list names, delete, erase all, or import When you want to check the list again from
When the confirmation function is on, the sys- contact.” Say “Edit name.” the beginning, answer “Yes.”
tem will check the target name and location 4. The voice guide will say “Please say the When you are done, answer “No” to return to
again. Answer “Yes” if you want to continue name of the entry you would like to edit, or the previous or main menu.
with the editing. say list names.” Say the name you want to edit.
Answer “No” to return to Step 3. NOTE
6. The voice guide will say “Number please.” NOTE
Say the telephone number you want to register. l You can call, edit or delete a name that is be-
l Say “List names,” and the names registered ing read out.
in the phone book will be read out in order. Press the SPEECH button and say “Call” to
NOTE Refer to “Vehicle phone book: Listening to call the name, “Edit name” to edit it, or “De-
l If the telephone number is already registered the list of registered names” on page 5-60. lete” to delete it.
in the selected location, the voice guide will The system will beep and then execute your
say “The current number is <current num- 5. The voice guide will say “Changing <name>.” command.
ber>. New number, please.” Say a new tele- When the confirmation function is on, the sys- l If you press the SPEECH button and say “Con-
phone number to change the current number. tem will ask if the name is correct. Answer tinue” or “Previous” while the list is being
“Yes” if you want to continue with the edit- read, the system will advance or rewind the
7. The voice guide will repeat the telephone ing based on this information. list. Say “Continue” to proceed to the next en-
try or “Previous” to return to the previous en-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
number. Answer “No” to return to Step 4.
When the confirmation function is on, the sys- 6. The voice guide will say “Name please.” Say try.
tem will ask if the number is correct. Answer
“Yes.”
the new name you want to register.
7. The registered name will be changed.
5
[Deleting a telephone number]
Answer “No” to return to Step 3. When the change is complete, the system 1. Press the SPEECH button.
8. Once the telephone number is registered, the will return to the main menu. 2. Say “Phone book.”
voice guide will say “Number saved” and 3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the
then the system will return to the main menu. [Listening to the list of registered names] following: new entry, edit number, edit
1. Press the SPEECH button. name, list names, delete, erase all, or import
NOTE 2. Say “Phone book.” contact.” Say “Delete.”
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the 4. The voice guide will say “Please say the
l If the location where a telephone number
name of the entry you would like to delete,
was already registered has been overwritten following: new entry, edit number, edit
with a new number, the voice guide will say name, list names, delete, erase all, or import or say list names.” Say the name of the
“Number changed” and then the system will contact.” Say “List names.” phone book entry in which the telephone num-
return to the main menu. 4. Bluetooth® 2.0 interface will read out the en- ber you want to delete is registered.
tries in the phone book in order.
[Editing a name]
1. Press the SPEECH button.
OCRE12E1 5-63
For pleasant driving
NOTE You can delete all registered information from the The Bluetooth® 2.0 interface automatically con-
l Say “List names,” and the names registered vehicle phone book. verts from text to voice the names registered in the
in the phone book will be read out in order. 1. Press the SPEECH button. transferred phone book entries, and creates names.
Refer to “Vehicle phone book: Listening to 2. Say “Phone book.”
the list of registered names” on page 5-60. 3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the
following: new entry, edit number, edit
NOTE
5. If only one telephone number is registered in name, list names, delete, erase all, or import l Only the mobile phone book transferred
contact.” Say “Erase all.” from the connected cellular phone can be
the selected phone book entry, the voice used with that cellular phone.
guide will say “Deleting <name> <location>.” 4. For confirmation purposes, the voice guide
If multiple telephone numbers are registered will ask “Are you sure you want to erase ev- l You cannot change the names and telephone
erything from your handsfree system phone numbers in the phone book entries registered
in the selected phone book entry, the voice in the mobile phone book. You cannot select
guide will say “Would you like to delete book?” Answer “Yes.”
Answer “No” to cancel the deletion of all reg- and delete specific phone book entries, either.
[home], [work], [mobile], [other], or all?” To change or delete any of the above, change
Select the location to delete, and the voice istered information in the phone book and re-
turn to the main menu. the applicable information in the source
guide will say “Deleting <name> <location>.” phone book of the cellular phone and then
5. The voice guide will say “You are about to
delete everything from your hands-free sys- transfer the phone book again.
NOTE tem phone book. Do you want to continue?”
l To delete the telephone numbers from all lo- Answer “Yes” to continue. To import a devices phone book
cations, say “All.” Follow the steps below to transfer to the mobile
Answer “No” to cancel the deletion of all reg-
istered information in the phone book and re- phone book the phone book stored in the cellular
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6. The system will ask if you really want to de- turn to the main menu. phone.
lete the selected telephone number(s) to go
5 ahead with the deletion, answer “Yes.”
6. The voice guide will say “Please wait, eras-
ing the handsfree system phone book” and NOTE
Answer “No,” the system will cancel delet- then the system will delete all data in the
ing the telephone number(s) and then return phone book.
l Transfer should be completed while the vehi-
cle is parked.
to Step 4. When the deletion is complete, the voice Before transferring, make sure that the vehi-
7. When the deletion of the telephone number guide will say “Hands-free system phone cle is parked in a safe location.
is completed, the voice guide will say book erased” and then the system will return
“<name> <location> deleted” and then the to the main menu.
l The already stored phone book in the mobile
phone book is overwritten by the stored
system will return to the main menu.
phone book in the cellular phone.
If all locations are deleted, the system will
say “<name> and all locations deleted” and
Mobile phone book l All or part of data may not be transferred,
E00763900048 even when the cellular phone supports Blue-
the name will be removed from the phone All entries in the phone book stored in the cellular
book. If numbers still remain under the en- tooth®, depending on the compatibility of the
phone can be transferred in a batch and registered device.
try, the name will retain the other associated in the mobile phone book.
numbers. Up to 7 mobile phone books, each containing up to l Only a home, a work, and a mobile number
can be imported.
1,000 names, can be registered.
Erasing the phone book
5-64 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
l The maximum supported telephone number l If you press the HANG-UP button or press
length is 19 digits. Any telephone number of and hold the SPEECH button during the data
20 digits or more will be truncated to the transfer, the transfer will be cancelled and
first 19 digits. the system will return to the main menu.
l If telephone numbers contain characters oth- l If an error occurs during the data transfer, all
er than 0 to 9, *, # or +, these characters are transfer will be cancelled and the voice guide
deleted before the transfer. will say “Unable to complete the phone book
l For the connection settings on the cellular import” and then the system will return to
phone side, refer to the instructions for the the main menu.
cellular phone. l If there are no contacts in the phone book,
the voice guide will say “There are no con-
1. Press the SPEECH button. tacts on the connected phone.”
2. Say “Phone book.”
3. The voice guide will say “Select one of the 6. When the transfer is complete, the voice
following: new entry, edit number, edit guide will say “Import complete” and then
name, list names, delete, erase all, or import the system will return to the main menu.
contact.” Say “Import contact.”
4. The voice guide will say “Would you like to
import a single entry or all contacts?” Say
“All contacts.”
5. The voice guide will say “Importing the con-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
tact list from the mobile phone book. This
may take several minutes to complete.
Would you like to continue?” Answer “Yes,”
5
transferring to the mobile phone book the
phone book stored in the cellular phone will
start.
Answer “No,” to return to the main menu.
NOTE
l The transfer may take some time to complete
depending on the number of contacts.
l If the Bluetooth® 2.0 interface could not be
connected to the Bluetooth® compatible cel-
lular phone, the voice guide will say “Unable
to transfer contact list from phone” and then
the system will return to the main menu.
OCRE12E1 5-65
For pleasant driving
Enrollment commands
E00732400249
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
5-66 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
USB input terminal* Be sure to hold the terminal part (D) of the
connector cable as shown in the illustration.
Be sure to hold the terminal part (D) of the
connector cable as shown in the illustration.
E00761900015
You can connect your USB memory device or
iPod* to play music files stored in the USB memo-
ry device or iPod.
The following explains how to connect and remove
a USB memory device or iPod.
Refer to the following sections for details on how
to play music files:
Refer to “To play tracks from USB device” on
page 5-27.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
2. Open the glove box and remove the connec-
tor cable (A) from clips (B). juries.
To connect
1. Park your vehicle in a safe place and turn the 5
NOTE ignition switch to the “LOCK” position.
l When closing the glove box, be careful not 2. Open the glove box and remove the connec-
to trap the connector cable and USB memory tor cable (A) from clips (B).
device.
To remove
1. Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK” posi-
tion.
2. Remove the USB memory device (C).
OCRE12E1 5-67
For pleasant driving
3. Connect the Dock connector (C) to the iPod Types of connectable devices and sup-
(D). CAUTION ported file specifications
l Keep the lid of the glove box closed while Device types
E00762200015
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
nector cable (A). Models other than USB Digital audio player sup-
memory devices and porting mass storage
5 Be sure to hold the terminal part (E) of the
connector cable as shown in the illustration. iPods class
*:“iPod touch,” “iPod classic,” “iPod” and “iPod
nano” are registered trademarks of Apple Inc. in
the United States and other countries.
NOTE
l Depending on the type of the USB memory
device or other device connected, the connec-
3. Fix the connector cable on the clips and ted device may not function properly or the
close the glove box. available functions may be limited.
l Use the iPod whose firmware has been upda-
ted to the latest version.
5-68 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Item Condition
MP3, WMA, AAC,
5
File format
WAV
Maximum number of
levels (including the Level 8
root)
Number of folders 700
Number of files 65,535
OCRE12E1 5-69
For pleasant driving
Vanity mirror* Ashtray To remove the ashtray, pull it out while pressing
the stop (A).
E00711300489 E00711400826
A vanity mirror is fitted to the back of the sun visor
on the passenger side.
CAUTION
l Put out matches and cigarettes before
they are placed in the ashtray.
l Don’t put papers and other things that
burn into your ashtrays. If you do, ciga-
rettes or other smoking materials could
set them on fire, causing damage.
l Always close the ashtray. If left open, oth-
er cigarette butts in the ashtray may be re-
kindled.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
5-70 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
CAUTION
l Do not touch heating element or lighter
housing. Hold only the knob to prevent
For the rear seat burns.
l Do not allow children to operate or play
with the cigarette lighter as burns may oc-
cur.
l Something is wrong with the cigarette
lighter if it does not pop back out within
approximately 30 seconds of being push-
ed in.
Type 2
Leaving the cigarette lighter pushed in
for an extended period could cause fire. If
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
it does not pop out by itself, we recom-
mend you to have it checked.
l Do not leave the cigarette lighter pushed 5
in or insert the cigarette lighter from an-
other vehicle. Otherwise, the lighter may
overheat and cause fire.
l It is recommended that only the lighter
be inserted in its socket.
Use of “plug-in” type accessories may
1- Push all the way in. damage the socket and result in poor re-
tention of the lighter.
The lighter will automatically return to its original
position with a “click” when ready. Pull it out for
use.
After use, insert the lighter to its original position
in the socket.
OCRE12E1 5-71
For pleasant driving
NOTE
l Long use of the electric appliance without run-
ning the engine may run down the battery.
Especially avoid using it with the cigarette
lighter.
Type 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
5-72 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1- To adjust the hour NOTE
2- To adjust the minutes
3- To reset the minutes to zero
l If you leave the lamps on without running
the engine, you will run down the battery. Be-
5
fore you leave the vehicle, make sure that all
the lamps are off.
10:30 - 11:29...... Changes to 11:00
11:30 - 12:29...... Changes to 12:00
NOTE
l If the battery cables are disconnected during
repairs or for any other reason, reset the
clock to the correct time after they are recon-
nected.
OCRE12E1 5-73
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
of the followings: again to turn it off.
5 l All doors are closed and the ig-
nition switch is turned to the
“ON” position.
l All doors are locked using the
key mechanism of the driver’s
door, the lock knob of the driv-
er’s door, or the remote con-
trol switch of the keyless entry
system (if so equipped).
5-74 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The centre console downlight go on when the lamp
switch is in the “ ” or the “ ” position. NOTE
Refer to “Combination headlamps and dipper l Do not leave valuables in any storage space
when leaving the vehicle.
5
switch” on page 3-30.
Type 1
OCRE12E1 5-75
For pleasant driving
1- Utility box*
2- Glove box
3- Sunglasses holder*
4- Seat under tray*
5- Front console box* Type 2
6- Floor console box* The glove box can be locked and unlocked using
7- Secret box (Club cab) Floor console box*
the key. E00723300633
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
E00717601478 To open, raise the lid.
5 NOTE
l When the lamp switch is in the “ ” or
“ ” position, the glove box lamp illumi-
nates.
Refer to “Combination headlamps and dip-
per switch” on page 3-30.
l The USB input terminal (if so equipped) is lo-
cated in the glove box.
For details, refer to “USB input terminal” on 1- To lock
page 5-67. 2- To unlock
3- To open, pull the lever
Type 2
Upper and lower boxes are located inside the floor
console box.
5-76 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
The floor console box can also be used as an armrest. Lower box Close the lid by pushing it till it clicks.
To open the lower box, lift the left release lever (B)
and raise the lid.
1- Upper box
2- Lower box
CAUTION
NOTE Utility box* l The holder should not be used to store any-
l The Auxiliary Audio connector (RCA) or the E00717900100 thing heavier than sunglasses. These ob-
Auxiliary Video connector (RCA) is located To open, pull up the knob (A). jects could drop out.
in the lower box (if so equipped). For details,
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
refer to “To use the external audio input func-
NOTE
tion” on page 5-39.
l The holder may not be able to accomodate ev- 5
Upper box ery possible size and shape of sunglasses; it
To open the upper box, lift the right release lever is advisable to check compatibility before use.
(A) and raise the lid.
Secret box (Club cab)
E00724900043
The secret box is in the floor behind the seat.
Sunglasses holder*
E00718600250
Push the lid to open.
OCRE12E1 5-77
For pleasant driving
CAUTION
l Do not drink beverages while driving the
vehicle; doing so could distract you and
result in an accident.
Type 1
To use
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Draw out the tray.
5
Type 2
To store
Push in the tray positively until it is fully locked.
5-78 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
NOTE
l Make sure the cap of any plastic bottle
placed in a bottle holder is tightly closed.
l The bottle holders may not accommodate bot-
tles of certain shapes and sizes.
For the rear seat (Double cab)
E00716900389
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
In order to use the cup holder, allow the armrest to For the front seat
The bottle holders are provided at both sides.
drop down.
5
OCRE12E1 5-79
For pleasant driving
NOTE
l Do not hang heavy luggage (more than about
4 kg) on the hook.
Doing so could cause damage to the hook.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5 WARNING
l Do not put a hanger or any heavy or poin-
ted object on the coat hook. If the curtain
airbag was activated, any such item could
be propelled away with great force and
could prevent the curtain airbag from in-
flating correctly. Hang clothes directly on
the coat hook (without using a hanger).
Make sure there are no heavy or sharp ob-
jects in the pockets of clothes that you
hang on the coat hook.
5-80 OCRE12E1
For pleasant driving
Club cab
A band for securing a first-aid kit is installed in the
secret box.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
5
OCRE12E1 5-81
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6
OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
start, and the bad grounding could damage l If electrolyte fluid is not visible, or ap-
pears to be frozen, Do Not Attempt Jump
the electrical systems.
Starting!
A battery might rupture or explode if the
temperature is below the freezing point
CAUTION
6 l Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-
or if it is not filled to the proper level.
6-02 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
from the battery because the battery may
produce an explosion.
CAUTION l Use adequate ventilation when charging
or using the battery in an enclosed space.
l Take care not to get the jumper cable l Remove all the caps before charging the
battery.
caught in the cooling fan or other rotat-
ing part in the engine compartment. l Electrolyte is corrosive diluted sulphuric 6
l Use the proper cables suitable for the bat- acid.
tery size. If electrolyte (battery acid) comes into con-
5. Connect one end of the other jumper cable to Otherwise heat damage to the cables tact with your hands, eyes, clothes and
the negative (-) terminal of the booster bat- could result. the painted surface of your vehicle, it
tery (B), and the other end to the engine l Check the jumper cables for damage and should be thoroughly flushed with water.
block of the vehicle with the discharged bat- corrosion before use. If electrolyte gets in your eyes, flush them
tery at the point farthest from the battery. with water immediately and thoroughly,
and get prompt medical attention.
6. Start the engine in the vehicle which has the
booster battery, let the engine idle a few mi-
nutes, then start the engine in the vehicle
with the discharged battery.
OCRE12E1 6-03
For emergencies
CAUTION Engine overheating 3. Confirm that the cooling fan is turning. If the
fan is not turning, stop the engine immediate-
E00800601985
If the water temperature gauge indication remains ly and have it checked.
l Do not attempt to start the engine by pull- in the overheating zone for a long time, the engine
ing or pushing the vehicle.
It could damage your vehicle. may be overheating. If this occurs, take the follow-
ing corrective measures:
l Always wear protective eye goggles when
1. Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
working near the battery.
2. Check whether steam is coming from the en-
l Keep the battery out of the reach of chil-
gine compartment.
dren.
[If steam does not come from the engine com-
NOTE partment]
l On vehicles with anti-lock brake system, if With the engine still running, raise the bon-
the vehicle is put in motion without fully net to ventilate the engine compartment.
charging the battery, it might cause the loss
of smooth engine operation and the antilock [If steam is coming from the engine compart-
brake warning lamp to illuminate. A- Radiator cap
ment]
Refer to “Anti-lock brake system (ABS)” on B- Cooling fan
Stop the engine, and when the steam stops,
page 4-44. C- Reserve tank
raise the bonnet to ventilate the engine com-
*: if so equipped
partment. Restart the engine.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
WARNING WARNING
l Do not open the bonnet while steam is com- l Be careful not to get your hands or
clothes caught in the cooling fan.
ing from the engine compartment. It
6 could cause steam or hot water to spurt
out, causing burns. Hot water could spurt
out even when there is no steam coming
out, and some parts will be very hot. Be
very careful when opening the bonnet.
l Be careful of hot steam, which could be
blowing off the reserve tank cap.
l Do not attempt to remove the radiator
cap while the engine is hot.
6-04 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6
WARNING
l If there is none, make sure that the en-
gine has cooled down before removing
the radiator cap, because hot steam or boil-
ing water otherwise will gush from the fill-
er port and may scald you.
OCRE12E1 6-05
For emergencies
Type 1, 2
1. Loosen the drain plug (A) of the fuel filter.
Type 1
CAUTION
l Do not smoke or have any other open
3. Tighten the air plug (A) when there are no flame near the vehicle while bleeding the
more bubbles in the fuel. fuel system. Type 2
l Be sure to carefully clean away any spilt
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4. Continue pumping until the hand pump (B)
becomes stiff. fuel which could ignite and cause a fire.
5. Finally, check to be sure that there is no leak-
age of fuel.
If in doubt, we recommend you to consult a
6 specialist for necessary information.
Type 2, 3
Pump the hand pump (A) at the top of the fuel fil-
ter until the hand pump becomes stiff.
Then try again to start the engine.
6-06 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Single cab
Type 1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6-05.) A- Tool (wheel nut wrench)
5. Check to be sure that the fuel filter indication B- Jack handle
lamp illuminates when the ignition switch is C- Jack
turned to “ON”, and that it goes off when the
engine is started. If in doubt, we recommend
you to consult a specialist for necessary infor-
mation.
6
CAUTION
l Do not smoke or have any other open
flame near the vehicle while bleeding the
fuel system.
l Be sure to carefully clean away any water
drained out because any fuel mixed with
the water could ignite and cause a fire.
OCRE12E1 6-07
For emergencies
Type 1
A- Tools
B- Jack handle
C- Jack A- Tool (wheel nut wrench)
B- Jack
Club cab A- Tool (wheel nut wrench) C- Jack handle
B- Jack handle
C- Jack Type 2
Type 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6
A- Tools A- Tools
B- Jack B- Jack
C- Jack handle A- Tools C- Wheel nut wrench
B- Jack handle D- Jack handle
C- Jack
6-08 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Tools Single cab, Club cab, Double cab 3. Remove the securing nut (E), and then take
E00801900382 1- Tool bag out the jack (F).
2- Wheel nut wrench
Type 1 3- Plier
4- Driver
Single cab, Double cab Club cab 5- Spanner
Single cab
The tools, jack, and jack handle are located behind
the seat.
1. Tip forward the seatback.
(Refer to “Folding the seatback forward” on 4. Remove the jack handle (G) from the holder
page 2-06.) (H), and take out the handle.
Single cab, Double cab 2. <Type 1>
1- Wheel nut wrench Remove the wheel nut wrench (A) from the
holder (B), and take out the wrench.
<Type 2>
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Club cab
1- Tool bag Remove the securing band (C), and then take
2- Wheel nut wrench out the tools (D).
Type 2
6
OCRE12E1 6-09
For emergencies
NOTE 3. Remove the securing band (A), and then take 5. Remove the jack handle (E) from the holder
l When stowing the jack handle, align the black- out the tools (B). (F), and then take out the jack handle.
marked part (I) of the jack handle with the
holder (J).
4. Remove the securing nut (C), and then take 6. Reverse the removing procedure when stor-
out the jack (D). ing the tools, jack and jack handle.
Club cab
The tools, jack, and jack handle are stored under
NOTE
the floor on the left-hand side of the cargo space.
l When stowing the jack handle, align the col-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. Raise the left side seat cushion. Refer to
oured marking on the jack handle with that
“Folding up the seat cushion (Club cab)” on
on the holder, and fit the jack in the holder.
page 2-07.
Tip forward the seatback of the driver seat.
Double cab
Slide the driver seat forward.
6 2. Open the lid. Except for vehicles with rear retractable power
window
The tool (wheel nut wrench only), jack, and jack
handle are located behind the rear seat.
1. Tip forward the seatback of the rear seat.
(Refer to “Folding the seatback forward” on
page 2-07.)
2. <Type 1>
Remove the wheel nut wrench (A) from the
holder (B), and take out the wrench.
<Type 2>
6-10 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Remove the securing band (C), and then take 4. Remove the jack handle (G) from the holder 1. Tip forward the seatback of the rear seat.
out the tools (D). (H), and take out the handle. (Refer to “Folding the seatback forward” on
page 2-07.)
2. <Type 1>
Remove the wheel nut wrench (A) from the
holder of the back panel (B), and take out the
wrench.
<Type 2>
Take out the tools (C) from the rear back
trim (D).
3. Remove the securing nut (E), and then take 5. Reverse the removing procedure when stor-
out the jack (F). ing the tool, jack and jack handle.
NOTE
l When stowing the jack handle, align the black-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
marked part (I) of the jack handle with the
holder (H). 3. Remove the securing nut (E), and then take
out the jack (F).
OCRE12E1 6-11
For emergencies
4. Remove the jack handle (G) from the holder To use the jack handle (Club cab, Dou- 3. While pressing the snap pin (F) on the assem-
of the back panel (H), and take out the handle. ble cab with rear retractable power bled handle (E), insert the white-marked han-
dle (G) until it is locked by snap pin as illus-
window only) trated.
E00802400124
1. While pressing the snap pin (A) on the han-
dle that has a black marking, withdraw and re-
move the inner handle (B).
NOTE
l When stowing the wheel nut wrench, insert it
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
into the holder on the back panel as illustrated. 2. Reverse the inner handle (B) then, while press-
ing the snap pin (C), insert it into the outer
handle (D) until it is locked by snap pin as il-
lustrated.
6-12 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
points shown in the illustration. Use the jack-
ing point closest to the tyre you wish to
change.
OCRE12E1 6-13
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Do not use the jack on a tilted or soft sur- NOTE
face. Otherwise, the jack might slip and l This jack is a 2 stage expansion type.
cause personal injury. Always use the
jack on a flat, hard surface. Before set- To lower the vehicle
ting the jack, make sure there are no 1. Put the notch (J) provided on the jack handle
6 sand or pebbles under the jack base. end on the valve (K) of the jack.
6-14 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
WARNING
l Be sure to open the release valve slowly.
If it is opened quickly, the vehicle will
drop abruptly and the jack may come out
of position, causing a serious accident. 6
CAUTION WARNING
l If the release valve is loosened too much l Stop jacking up the vehicle as soon as the
(2 or more turns) in the anticlockwise di- tyre is raised off the ground. It is danger-
rection, the jack’s oil will leak and the ous to raise the vehicle any higher.
jack cannot be used. l Do not get under your vehicle while using
the jack.
OCRE12E1 6-15
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
with rear retractable power window only)
l When removing the spare wheel, put on (Refer to “To use the jack handle” on page
gloves. Removing the spare wheel with 6-12.)
your bare hands may cause injury to the 2. Insert the jack handle (A) in the hole (B) be-
fingers. low the rear gate.
6
6-16 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
withdraw the jack handle, taking care not to (A) at the tyre that is diagonally opposite
turn it in the reverse direction. from the tyre (B) you are changing.
CAUTION
l The spare wheel should always be secure- 6
ly in position.
If a flat tyre is changed, put the flat tyre
in the spare wheel mounting position
with the wheel outer surface upward, and
use the wheel nut wrench to secure it firm-
2. Turn the wheel nut wrench (B) clockwise to ly.
wind up the chain.
OCRE12E1 6-17
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6 WARNING
l Mount the spare wheel with the valve
8. Find the closest jacking point to the flat tyre stem (F) facing outboard. If you cannot
(refer to “Jacking up the vehicle” on page see the valve stem (F), you have installed
6-13). Then position the jack and raise the ve- the wheel backwards.
hicle until the tyre is slightly off the ground. Operating the vehicle with the spare
9. Remove the wheel nuts with the wheel nut wheel installed backwards can cause vehi-
wrench, then take the wheel off. cle damage and result in an accident.
NOTE
l Put the spare wheel under the vehicle body
near the flat tyre. This makes it safer if the
jack slips out of position.
6-18 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
With a spare wheel, tighten the wheel nuts in
the same way. of the wheel nut wrench supplied with
Spare wheel (steel wheels) the vehicle.
Steel wheel: 510 to 580 N
Aluminium wheel: 440 to 500 N)
OCRE12E1 6-19
For emergencies
l Never use your foot or a pipe extension l The tyre pressure should be periodically
If a wheel gets stuck in a ditch, do not try to tow
for extra force in the wheel nut wrench. checked and maintained at the specified
the vehicle. Please contact your MITSUBISHI
If you do so, you will tighten the nut too pressure while the tyre is stowed.
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or a commer-
much. l After changing the tyre and driving the ve-
cial tow truck service for assistance.
hicle about 1,000 km (620 miles), retight-
en the wheel nuts to make sure that they
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
13. Lower and remove the jack, then store the Only when you cannot receive a towing service
have not come loose.
jack, jack handle, wheel nut wrench, flat from a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Serv-
tyre, and chocks. Have your damaged tyre re- l If the steering wheel vibrates when driv-
ice Point or commercial tow truck service, tow
ing after changing the tyre, we recom-
paired as soon as possible. your vehicle carefully in accordance with the in-
mend you to have the tyres checked for
14. Check your tyre inflation pressure. The cor- structions given in “Emergency towing” in this part.
balance.
rect pressures are shown on the door label.
6 See the illustration. l Do not mix one type of tyre with another
or use a different size from the one listed.
This would cause early wear and poor han-
dling.
6-20 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
The regulations concerning towing may differ from Towing the vehicle by a tow truck
country to country. It is recommended that you CAUTION
obey the regulations of the area where you are driv-
l If you tow a vehicle with automatic trans-
ing your vehicle. CAUTION mission with the driving wheels on the
ground (Type B) as illustrated, make sure
l This vehicle must not be towed by a tow
that the towing speed and distance given
truck using sling lift type equipment
below are never exceeded, causing dam-
(Type A) as illustrated. Using a sling lift
age to the transmission.
will damage the bumper and front end.
l On 4WD vehicles, be sure to shift the trans-
Towing speed: 50 km/h (30 mph)
fer shift lever to “2H” position and trans-
Towing distance: 50 km (30 miles)
port the vehicle with the driving wheels
on a carriage (Type C, D or E) as illustra-
For the towing speed and the towing dis-
ted. Never try to tow with the transfer
tance, follow the local driving laws and
shift lever in “4H” or “4L” position (easy
regulations.
select 4WD), “4H”, “4HLc” or “4LLc” po-
sition (super select 4WD) and with the
front or rear wheels on the ground (Type Towing with front wheels off the ground (Type B)
B or C) as illustrated. This could result in Place the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi-
driving system damage or the vehicle tion (manual transmission) or the selector lever in
may jump at the carriage. If you cannot the “N” (NEUTRAL) position (automatic transmis-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
shift the transfer shift lever to the “2H” sion).
position or the transmission is malfunc- Release the parking brake.
tioning or damaged, transport the vehicle
with all wheels on a carriage (Type D or
E) as illustrated. CAUTION
l If your vehicle equipped with the Active
Stability & Traction Control system l Never tow an automatic transmission ve- 6
hicle with the front wheels up (and the
(ASTC), if the vehicle is towed with the ig-
rear wheels on the ground) (Type B)
nition switch in the “ON” position and on-
when the automatic transmission fluid lev-
ly the front wheels or only the rear
el is low. This may cause serious and ex-
wheels raised off the ground, the active
pensive damage to the transmission.
Traction Control System may operate, re-
sulting in an accident.
l On 2WD vehicles, if the transmission is
malfunctioning or damaged, transport
the vehicle with the driving wheels on a
carriage (Type C, D or E) as illustrated.
OCRE12E1 6-21
For emergencies
Towing with rear wheels off the ground (Type C) Front (2WD vehicles with 16 inch wheels and l Take care that the tow rope is kept as horizon-
Place the gearshift lever in the “N” (Neutral) posi- 4WD vehicles) tal as possible. An angled tow rope can dam-
tion (manual transmission) or the selector lever in age the vehicle body.
the “N” (NEUTRAL) position (automatic transmis- l Secure the tow rope to the same side towing
sion). Turn the ignition key to the “ACC” position hook, to keep the tow rope as straight as pos-
and secure the steering wheel in a straight ahead po- sible.
sition with a rope or tie-down strap. Never place
the ignition switch in the “LOCK” position when 2. Keep the engine running.
towing. If the engine is not running, turn the ignition
key to the “ACC” or “ON” position to un-
Emergency towing lock the steering wheel.
If towing service is not available in an emergency,
your vehicle may be temporarily towed by a cable
or chain secured to the towing hook. CAUTION
If your vehicle is to be towed by another vehicle,
Rear*
pay careful attention to the following points. l When the engine is not running, the
brake booster and power steering pump
If your vehicle is to be towed by anoth- do not operate. This means higher brake
depression force and higher steering ef-
er vehicle fort are required. Therefore, vehicle oper-
1. The front towing hooks (A) and rear towing ation is more difficult than usual.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
hook (B) are located as shown in the illustra-
tion. Secure the tow rope to the towing hook.
l Do not leave the key in the “LOCK” posi-
tion. The steering wheel will lock, causing
loss of control.
6-22 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
NOTE NOTE
WARNING l Using any part other than the designated tow- l Your vehicle should only be used to tow an-
l To prevent entry of exhaust gas from the ing hook could result in damage to the vehi- other vehicle if the weight of the other vehi-
towing vehicle, set your air selection lever cle body. cle is less than the weight of your vehicle.
to the recirculation position.
l Avoid sudden braking, sudden accelera-
tion and sharp turning; such operation
could cause damage to the towing hooks
or the tow rope.
People in the vicinity could be injured as
a result.
l When towing or being towed down a long
slope, the brakes may overheat reducing
the effectiveness. In this situation, have
your vehicle transported by a tow truck.
l When the vehicle with automatic trans-
mission is to be towed by another vehicle
with all the wheels on the ground, make
sure that the towing speed and distance
given below are never exceeded, causing CAUTION
damage to the transmission.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l On vehicles with super select 4WD, when
you are going to tow another vehicle,
Towing speed: 50 km/h (30 mph) move the transfer shift lever to “4H” posi-
Towing distance: 50 km (30 miles) tion.
Selecting “2H” drive may increase the dif-
For the towing speed and the towing dis-
tance, follow the local driving laws and
ferential oil temperature, resulting in pos-
sible damage to the driving system. 6
regulations. Further, the drive train will be subjected
to excessive loading possibly leading to oil
If your vehicle tows another vehicle (vehicles with leakage, component seizure, or other seri-
rear towing hook only) ous faults.
The rear towing hook is located as shown in the il-
lustration. Secure the tow rope to the rear towing
hook.
OCRE12E1 6-23
For emergencies
Operation under adverse driving NOTE l Depressing the brake pedal during travel on
snowy or icy roads may cause tyre slippage
conditions l Depress the accelerator pedal gradually when
starting the vehicle. and skidding. When traction between the
E00801702140
tyres and the road is reduced the wheels may
On a flooded road skid and the vehicle cannot readily be
If your vehicle becomes stuck in sand, brought to a stop by conventional braking
mud or snow l Avoid flooded roads. Water could enter the
techniques. Braking will differ, depending
brake discs, resulting in temporarily ineffec-
If the vehicle becomes stuck in snow, sand, or tive brakes. In such cases, lightly depress the upon whether you have anti-lock brake sys-
mud, it can often be moved with a rocking motion. brake pedal to see if the brakes operate prop- tem (ABS). If you do have ABS, brake by
Move the selector lever alternately between the erly. If they do not, lightly depress the pedal pressing the brake system pedal hard, and
“L” (LOW) and “R” (REVERSE) position (with several times while driving in order to dry keeping it pressed. If you do not have ABS,
manual transmission, between 1st and Reverse), the brake pads. pump the brake pedal with short rapid jabs,
while applying slight pressure to the accelerator ped- each time fully applying and fully releasing
al.
l When driving in rain or on a road with many
for greatest effect.
puddles a layer of water may form between
Avoid racing the engine or spinning the wheels. Pro- the tyres and the road surface. l Allow extra distance between your vehicle
longed efforts to free a stuck vehicle may result in This reduces a tyre’s frictional resistance on and the vehicle in front of you, and avoid sud-
overheating and transmission failure. Allow the en- the road, resulting in loss of steering stability den braking.
gine to idle for a few minutes to let the transmis- and braking capability. l Accumulation of ice on the braking system
sion cool between rocking attempts. can cause the wheels to lock. Pull away from
If the vehicle remains stuck after several rocking at- To cope with this, observe the following items: a standstill slowly after confirming safety
tempts, seek other assistance. around the vehicle.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
(a) Drive your vehicle at slow speed.
6-24 OCRE12E1
For emergencies
CAUTION
l The impact on tyres and/or wheels when
driving on a bumpy or rutted road can
damage the tyre and/or wheel.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6
OCRE12E1 6-25
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Vehicle care
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
7
OCRE12E1
Vehicle care
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ways follow the instructions and always l Always read the instructions on the cleaner la-
open your vehicle doors or windows when 2. Clean the carpeting with a vacuum cleaner
bel. and remove any stains with carpet cleaner.
you’re cleaning the inside. Never use the
following to clean your vehicle: Oil and grease can be removed by lightly dab-
• Petrol Plastic, vinyl leather, fabric and bing with a clean colourfast cloth and stain re-
• Paint Thinner flocked parts mover.
E00900300377
• Benzine
• Kerosene 1. Gently wipe off with gauze or other soft Genuine leather*
• Turpentine cloth soaked with a 3 % aqueous solution of E00900600817
7 • Naphtha
• Lacquer Thinner
neutral detergent.
2. Dip cloth in fresh water and wring out well.
1. Gently wipe off with gauze or other soft
cloth soaked with a 5 % aqueous solution of
• Carbon Tetrachloride Using this cloth, wipe off the detergent thor- neutral detergent.
• Nail Polish Remover oughly. 2. Dip cloth in fresh water and wring it out
• Acetone well. Using this cloth, wipe off the detergent
thoroughly.
l These are all dangerous, and can damage
3. Apply leather protecting agent to the genuine
your vehicle.
leather surface.
7-02 OCRE12E1
Vehicle care
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
stick to the seat. be effective in protecting it from environmental el-
may result in flooding of the vehicle inte-
ements such as rain, snow, salt air, etc.
rior. Therefore; observe the following.
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight. Park the
• Maintain a distance of approx. 50 cm
vehicle in the shade and spray it with water to re-
or more between the vehicle body and
move dust. Next, using an ample amount of clean
the washing nozzle.
water and a car washing brush or sponge, wash the
• When washing around the door glass,
vehicle from top to bottom.
hold the nozzle at a distance of more
Use a mild car washing soap if necessary. Rinse
than 50 cm and at right angles to the
thoroughly and wipe dry with a soft cloth. After
washing the vehicle, carefully clean the joints and
glass surface.
7
flanges of the doors, bonnet, etc., where dirt is like-
ly to remain.
OCRE12E1 7-03
Vehicle care
NOTE
CAUTION l To prevent freezing of the weatherstripping CAUTION
l After washing the vehicle, drive the vehi- on the doors, bonnet, etc., they should be trea- l On vehicles with a sunroof, be careful
cle slowly while lightly depressing the ted with silicone spray. when waxing the area around the sunroof
brake pedal several times in order to dry opening, not to put any wax on the weath-
out the brakes. Waxing erstrip (black rubber). If stained with
Leaving the brakes wet could result in re- E00901000687 wax, the weatherstrip cannot maintain a
duced braking performance. Also, there Waxing the vehicle will help prevent the adherence weatherproof seal with the sunroof.
is a possibility that they could freeze up of dust and road chemicals to the paintwork. Apply
or become inoperative due to rust, render- a wax solution after washing the vehicle, or at least
ing the vehicle unable to move. once every three months to assist displacing of water. Polishing
E00901100011
l When using an automatic car wash, pay Do not wax your vehicle in direct sunlight. You
The vehicle should only be polished if the paint-
attention to the following items, referring should wax after the surfaces have cooled.
work has become stained or lost its lustre. Matt-fin-
to the operation manual or consulting a
ish parts and plastic bumpers must not be polished,
car wash operator. If the following proce-
polishing these parts will stain them or damage
dure is not followed, it could result in dam- CAUTION their finish.
age to your vehicle.
• The outside mirrors are retracted. l Waxes containing high abrasive com-
Damaged paint
• If your vehicle is equipped with the pil- pounds should not be used. Such waxes re- E00901200155
lar antenna, it can be retracted. move rust and stains effectively from the Small cracks and scratches in the paint coat should
• If your vehicle is equipped with the paintwork but they are harmful to the lus- be touched up as soon as possible with
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
roof antenna, it can be removed. tre on the painted surface and the plated MITSUBISHI touch-up paint to prevent corrosion.
surface. Check body areas facing the road or the tyres care-
Further, they are harmful to glossy surfa- fully for damage to the paint coat caused by flying
During cold weather ces such as grille, garnish, mouldings, etc.
Salt and other chemicals spread on the roads in stones, etc. The paint code number for your vehicle
some areas in winter can have a harmful effect on
l Do not use petrol or paint thinners to re- can be found on the vehicle information code plate.
move road tar or other contamination to (Refer to “Vehicle labeling” on page 9-02.)
the vehicle body. You should therefore wash the ve- the vehicle surface.
hicle as often as possible in accordance with our
care-instructions. It is recommended to have a pres-
l Do not apply wax on the areas having Cleaning plastic parts
black mat coating as it can cause uneven
7
E00901300446
ervative applied and the underfloor protection discolouration, patches, blurs, etc. If Use a sponge or chamois leather.
checked before and after the cold weather season. stained with wax, immediately wipe off If a car wax adheres on a grey or black rough sur-
After washing your vehicle, wipe off all water- with a piece of soft cloth and warm water. face of the bumper, moulding or lamps, the surface
drops from the rubber parts around the doors to pre- becomes white. In such a case, wipe it off using
vent the doors from freezing. lukewarm water and soft cloth or chamois leather.
7-04 OCRE12E1
Vehicle care
Wiper blades
CAUTION CAUTION E00901700017
Use a soft cloth and glass cleaner to remove grease,
l Do not use a scrubbing brush or other l Do not use a brush or other hard imple- dead insects, etc., from the wiper blades. Replace
hard tools as they may damage the plastic ment on the wheels.
the wiper blades when they no longer wipe proper-
part surface. Doing so could scratch the wheels.
ly. (Refer to page “Wiper blades” on page 8-17.)
l Do not use wax containing compound (pol- l Do not use any cleaner that contains an
ishing powder) which may damage the abrasive substance or is acidic or alka- Cleaning the sunroof*
plastic part surface. line. Doing so could cause the coating on E00901800180
l Do not bring the plastic parts into contact the wheels to peel or become discoloured Clean the inside of the sunroof with a soft cloth.
with petrol, light oil, brake fluids, engine or stained. Hard deposits should be wiped away with a cloth
oils, greases, paint thinners, and sulphu- l Do not directly apply hot water using a dipped in warm, neutral detergent solution. Wipe
ric acid (battery electrolyte) which may steam cleaner or by any other means. away the solution with a sponge dipped in fresh wa-
crack, stain or discolour the plastic parts. l Contact with seawater and road deicer ter.
If they touch the plastic parts, wipe them can cause corrosion. Rinse off such sub-
off with soft cloth, chamois or the like stances as soon as possible. NOTE
and an aqueous solution of neutral deter-
gent then immediately rinse the affected l The surface treatment on the inside of the
Window glass glass may be removed if hard cloth or organ-
parts with water.
E00901600058 ic solvent (benzine, kerosene, thinner, etc.) is
The window glass can normally be cleaned using used.
Chrome parts only a sponge and water.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
E00901400014 Glass cleaner can be used to remove oil, grease, Engine compartment
In order to prevent spots and corrosion of chrome dead insects, etc. After washing the glass, wipe dry E00902100265
parts, wash with water, dry thoroughly, and apply a with a clean, dry, soft cloth. Never use the same Clean the engine compartment at the beginning and
special protective coating. This should be done cloth to wipe the window glass as would be used to end of winter. Pay particular attention to flanges,
more frequently in winter. wipe the paintwork; wax from the painted surfaces crevices and peripheral parts where dust containing
could adhere to the glass and reduce its transparen- road chemicals and other corrosive materials might
Aluminium wheels* cy and visibility. collect.
E00901500116
1. Remove dirt using a sponge while sprinkling If salt and other chemicals are used on the roads in
NOTE your area, clean the engine compartment at least ev-
water on the vehicle.
2. Use neutral detergent on any dirt that cannot l To clean the inside of the rear window, al- ery three months. 7
be removed easily with water. ways use a soft cloth and wipe the window Never spray or splash water on the electrical com-
Rinse off the neutral detergent after washing glass along the demister heater element so as ponents in the engine compartment, as this may
the vehicle. not to cause damage. cause damage.
3. Dry the vehicle thoroughly using a chamois Do not bring the nearby parts, the plastic parts and
leather or a soft cloth. so on into contact with sulphuric acid (battery elec-
trolyte) which may crack, stain or discolour them.
OCRE12E1 7-05
Vehicle care
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
7
7-06 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Service precautions.......................................................................8-02
Catalytic converter........................................................................8-02
Bonnet...........................................................................................8-03
Engine oil......................................................................................8-04
Engine coolant..............................................................................8-06
Automatic transmission fluid*......................................................8-07
Washer fluid.................................................................................8-08
Brake fluid....................................................................................8-08
Clutch fluid*.................................................................................8-09
Power steering fluid......................................................................8-09
Battery..........................................................................................8-10
Tyres.............................................................................................8-11
Clutch pedal free play*.................................................................8-15
Brake pedal free play....................................................................8-16
Parking brake lever stroke............................................................8-16
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Wiper blades.................................................................................8-17
General maintenance....................................................................8-18
For cold and snowy weather.........................................................8-19
Fusible links..................................................................................8-19
Fuses.............................................................................................8-20
Replacement of lamp bulbs..........................................................8-23
OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l When checking or servicing the inside of Continued operation of your vehicle with
the engine compartment, make sure the a severe overheated condition may result
engine is switched off and has had a in possible damage to the converter and
chance to cool down. vehicle.
l If it is necessary to do work in the engine
compartment with the engine running, be
especially careful that your clothing, hair,
etc., does not become caught by the fans,
WARNING
drive belts, or other moving parts. l As with any vehicle, do not park or oper-
l For vehicle with air conditioning, the fan ate this vehicle in areas where combusti-
may turn on automatically even if the en- ble materials such as dry grass or leaves
gine is not running; turn the ignition key can come in contact with a hot exhaust
to “LOCK” position and remove the key since a fire could occur.
8 to ensure safety while you work in the en- l Paint should not be applied to the catalyt-
gine compartment. ic converter.
8-02 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
RHD
formance is noticeably low, or if the engine
Support the bonnet by inserting the support bar in
has a malfunction such as with the ignition,
its slot.
etc.
If it is impractical to stop driving immediate-
ly, reduce the speed and drive for only a
short time. We recommend you to have your
vehicle inspected as soon as possible.
l In unusual situations involving major engine
problems, a burnt smell may indicate severe
and abnormal catalyst overheating.
If this occurs, the vehicle should be stopped
in a safe place, the engine switched off and
the vehicle allowed to cool. Once the engine
is cool, a service, including a tune-up to man- 8
ufacturer’s specifications, should be obtained
immediately.
OCRE12E1 8-03
Maintenance
l Note that the support bar may disengage l Be careful that hands or fingers are not
the bonnet if the open bonnet is lifted by trapped when closing the bonnet. To check and refill engine oil
a strong wind. l Before driving, make sure that the bon- A- Minimum level
l Always insert the support bar into the net is securely locked. An incompletely B- Maximum level
hole provided specifically for this pur- locked bonnet can suddenly open while C- Oil replacement indication mark
pose. Supporting the bonnet at any other driving. This can be extremely dangerous.
location could result in the support bar Type 1 Type 2
slipping out and lead to an accident.
To close
Unlatch the support bar and clip it in its holder.
Slowly lower the bonnet to a position about 20 cm
above the closed position, then let it drop.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The engine oil used has a significant effect on the
engine’s performance, service life and startability.
Be sure to use oil of the recommended quality and
appropriate viscosity.
All engines consume a certain amount of oil during
normal operation. Therefore, it is important to
check the oil level at regular intervals or before start-
ing a long trip.
1. Park the car on a horizontal surface.
NOTE 2. Switch off the engine.
l If this does not close the bonnet, release it 3. Wait a few minutes.
from a slightly higher position. 4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it with a clean
8 l Do not press down the bonnet hard with a
hand as it may damage the bonnet.
cloth.
5. Reinsert the dipstick as far as it goes.
6. Remove the dipstick and read the oil level,
which should always be within the range in-
dicated.
8-04 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
7. If the oil level is below the specified limit, re- • On vehicles with DPF, the engine oil will • API classification:
move the cap located on the cylinder head increase due to a little fuel getting mixed “For service CF-4”
cover and add enough oil to raise the level to in the engine oil when the DPF regener-
within the specified range. Do not overfill to ates to burn away the PM (particulate mat- NOTE
avoid engine damage. Be sure to use the speci- ter). However, it does not indicate a mal-
fied engine oil and do not mix various types function. l Use of additives is not recommended since
they may reduce the effectiveness of addi-
of oil. l The engine oil will deteriorate rapidly if the
tives already included in the engine oil. It
8. After adding oil, close the cap securely. vehicle is subjected to severe conditions, re-
may result in failure of the mechanical assem-
9. Confirm the oil level by repeating step 4 to 6. quiring earlier oil replacement. Please refer
bly.
to the maintenance schedule.
l For handling of used engine oils, refer to Vehicles with diesel particulate filter (DPF)
Use only the recommended oils with an ACEA or page 05.
API classification as specified in this manual.
Selection of engine oil
NOTE Vehicles without diesel particulate filter (DPF)
l Check or refill the oil according to the follow-
ing manner.
• When the oil level is checked in step 6
above, check it on a low side of the dip-
stick because it is different in appearance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
of oil level in the two sides of the dipstick.
• On vehicles without diesel particulate fil-
ter (DPF), the oil level should be within
the range (A) to (B) on the dipstick.
• On vehicles with DPF, the oil level
should be within the range (A) to (C) (oil l Select engine oil of the proper SAE viscosity
replacement indication mark) on the dip- number according to the atmospheric temper-
stick. ature.
If the oil level is beyond the oil replace- l Use engine oil conforming to the following
ment indication mark (C), replace the oil classification:
as soon as possible. l Select engine oil of the proper SAE viscosity • ACEA classification:
number according to the atmospheric temper- “For service C1, C2, C3 or C4”
Then, the oil should be refilled to the max-
ature. • JASO classification:
imum level (B).
l Use engine oil conforming to the following
classification:
“For service DL-1”
If those classifications are not available, con-
8
• ACEA classification: tact a MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized
“For service A1/ B1, A3/B3, A3/B4, Service Point.
A5/B5”
OCRE12E1 8-05
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
ages in the radiator, heater, cylinder head, engine
block, etc.
Because of the necessity of this anti-corrosion
To add coolant agent, the coolant must not be replaced with plain
The cooling system is a closed system and normal-
water even in summer. The required concentration
ly the loss of coolant should be very slight. A no-
of anti-freeze differs depending on the expected am-
ticeable drop in the coolant level could indicate leak-
bient temperature.
age. If this occurs, we recommend you to have the
system checked as soon as possible. Ambient
If the level should drop below the “LOW” level on temperature -15 -20 -25 -30 -35 -50
the reserve tank, open the lid and add coolant. (minimum) °C
Also, if the reserve tank is completely empty, re-
move the radiator cap and add coolant until the lev- Anti-freeze
8 el reaches the filler neck. concentra-
tion %
30 35 40 45 50 60
8-06 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
CAUTION Automatic transmission fluid* 7. Remove dipstick and read the automatic trans-
mission fluid level.
E01000600974
The proper amount of automatic transmission fluid The fluid level should always be between the
l Do not use alcohol or methanol anti-
is essential to the life and operation of the automat- two marks on the dipstick.
freeze or any engine coolants mixed with
alcohol or methanol anti-freeze. The use ic transmission. Either insufficient fluid or exces-
of an improper anti-freeze can cause cor- sive fluid could cause transmission trouble. The
rosion of the aluminium components. transmission fluid filler port cap is equipped with a
dipstick. Use the following procedure to check the
l For effective anti-corrosion and anti-
fluid level.
freeze performance, keep the anti-freeze
concentration within the range of 30 to
60 %. Procedure for checking the fluid level
Concentrations exceeding 60 % will re- 1. Check the fluid level after the vehicle has
sult in a reduction of both the anti-freeze been driven enough to warm up the transmis-
and cooling performance thus adversely sion fluid.
affecting the engine. 2. Park the vehicle on a flat, level surface and
l Do not top up with water only. apply the parking brake.
Water by itself reduces the rust-protec- 3. With the engine idling and the brake pedal
tive and anti-freeze qualities of the cool- fully depressed, move the transmission selec-
tor lever through all the positions from the
ant and has a lower boiling point. It can
also cause damage to the cooling system if "P” (PARK) to “L” (LOW) (with 4A/T), the WARNING
it should freeze. Do not use tapwater, as it “P” (PARK) to “D” (DRIVE) (with 5A/T), l Do not spill the fluid onto a hot exhaust
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
can cause corrosion and rust formation. stopping momentarily at each position. manifold during topping up or inspec-
4. Move the selector lever to the “P” (PARK) tion, or a fire may occur.
position.
During cold weather 5. Remove the dipstick and wipe it with a clean
If the temperatures in your area drop below freez- lint-free cloth.
Fluid type
ing, there is the danger that the coolant in the en- 6. Reinsert the dipstick as far as it goes. Use only “DIA QUEEN ATF SP III” transmission
gine or radiator could freeze and cause severe dam- fluid to ensure optimum transmission performance.
age to the engine and/or radiator. The concentra-
tion should be checked before the start of cold weath-
er and anti-freeze added to the system if necessary.
Add a sufficient amount of anti-freeze to the cool-
ant to prevent it from freezing.
The concentration should be checked before the
start of cold weather and anti-freeze added to the 8
system if necessary.
OCRE12E1 8-07
Maintenance
Washer fluid Brake fluid In addition, the brake fluid reservoir is equipped
with a special cap to prevent the entrance of air,
E01000700672 E01000900687
The windscreen washer fluid reservoir is in the en- and this cap should not be removed.
gine compartment. To check the fluid level
Check the washer fluid level at regular intervals Check the brake fluid level in the reservoir.
and add washer fluid to reservoir if necessary. The brake fluid level must be between the “MAX” CAUTION
and “MIN” marks on the reservoir.
l Take care in handling brake fluid as it is
harmful to the eyes, may irritate your
skin and also damage painted surfaces.
l Use only the specified brake fluid.
Do not mix or add different brands of
brake fluid to prevent chemical reactions.
Do not let any petroleum-based fluid
touch, mix with, or get into the brake fluid.
This will damage the seals.
l Keep the reservoir tank cap closed to pre-
vent the brake fluid from deteriorating ex-
cept maintenance.
l Clean the filler cap before removing and
close the cap securely after maintenance.
NOTE
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l The washer fluid container serves the wind- The brake fluid level is monitored by a float. When
screen and headlamps (if so equipped). the brake fluid level falls below the “MIN” mark,
the brake fluid warning lamp lights up.
During cold weather The fluid level falls slightly with wear of the brake
To ensure proper operation of the washers at low pads, but this does not indicate any abnormality.
temperatures, use a fluid containing an anti-freez- If the brake fluid level falls markedly in a short
ing agent. length of time, it indicates leaks from the brake sys-
tem.
If this occurs, we recommend you to have the vehi-
cle checked.
Fluid type
8 Use brake fluid conforming to DOT3 or DOT4.
The brake fluid is hygroscopic. Too much moisture
in the brake fluid will adversely affect the brake sys-
tem, reducing the brake performance.
8-08 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Clutch fluid* A rapid fluid loss indicates a leak in the clutch sys-
tem which should be inspected by a MITSUBISHI
Power steering fluid
E01001000281 E01001100703
MOTORS Authorized Service Point or another spe-
To check the fluid level cialist and repaired immediately. To check the fluid level
The clutch fluid in the master cylinder should be Check the fluid level in the reservoir while the en-
checked when performing other underhood service. Fluid type gine is idling.
In addition, the system should be checked for leak- Brake fluid conforming to DOT 3 or DOT 4 should Check to make certain that the power steering fluid
age at the same time. be used. level is always between the “MAX” and “MIN” lev-
Check to make certain that the clutch fluid level is The reservoir cap must be fully tightened to avoid el markings on the fluid reservoir and refill the flu-
always between the “MAX” and “MIN” level mark- contamination from foreign matter or moisture. id, if necessary.
ings on the fluid reservoir. DO NOT ALLOW PETROLEUM-BASED FLUID
TO CONTACT, MIX WITH, OR OTHERWISE
CONTAMINATE THE BRAKE FLUID. SEAL
LHD
DAMAGE WILL RESULT.
WARNING
l Take care in handling brake fluid as it is
harmful to the eyes and may also cause
damage to painted surfaces. Wipe up any
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
spills immediately.
Fluid type
RHD Use “ATF DEXRON III or DEXRON II”.
OCRE12E1 8-09
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
To disconnect the battery cable, stop the engine,
first disconnect the negative (-) terminal and then
the positive (+) terminal.
When connecting the battery, first connect the posi-
tive (+) terminal and then the negative (-) terminal.
WARNING
NOTE l Keep sparks, cigarettes, and flames away
l Open the terminal cover (A) before discon- from the battery because the battery
necting or connecting the positive (+) termi- could explode.
The electrolyte level must be between the specified nal of the battery.
limit on the outside of the battery. Replenish with
distilled water as necessary.
8 The inside of the battery is divided into several com-
partments; remove the cap from each compartment
and fill to the upper mark. Do not top up beyond
the upper mark because spillage during driving
could cause damage.
8-10 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
l The battery electrolyte is extremely caus- l Do not bring the nearby parts, the plastic
tic. Do not allow it to come in contact parts and so on into contact with sulphu-
with your eyes, skin, clothing, or the pain- ric acid (battery electrolyte) which may WARNING
ted surfaces of the vehicle. Spilt electro- crack, stain or discolour them.
lyte should be flushed immediately with If they are in contact, wipe off with soft
l Driving with tyres that are worn, dam-
aged or improperly inflated can lead to a
ample amounts of water. cloth, chamois or the like and an aqueous loss of control or blow out of the tyres
Irritation to eyes or skin from contact solution of neutral detergent then imme- which can result in a collision with seri-
with electrolyte requires immediate medi- diately rinse the affected parts with plen- ous or fatal injury.
cal attention. ty of water.
l Ventilate when charging or using the bat-
tery in an enclosed space.
NOTE
l Keep the terminals clean. After the battery is
connected, apply terminal protection grease.
CAUTION To clean the terminals, use lukewarm water.
l Never disconnect the battery with the ig- l Check to see if the battery is securely instal-
nition switch in the “ON” position; doing led and cannot be moved during travel. Also
so could damage the vehicle’s electrical check each terminal for tightness.
components. l When the vehicle is to be left unused for a
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Never short-circuit the battery; doing so long period of time, remove the battery and
could cause it to overheat and be damaged. store it in a place where the battery fluid will
l Always wear protective eye goggles when not freeze. The battery should be stored only
working near the battery. in a fully charged condition.
l If the battery is to be quick-charged, first
disconnect the battery cables.
l In order to prevent a short circuit, be
sure to disconnect the negative (-) termi-
nal first.
l Keep it out of reach of children.
OCRE12E1 8-11
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
245/65R17 111S RF (200 kPa) (200 kPa) (200 kPa) (290 kPa)
{29 psi} {29 psi} {29 psi} {42 psi}
*: On vehicles with 195 size tyres, this size of snow tyres can also be used instead.
Check the tyre inflation pressure of all the tyres while they are cold; if insufficient or excessive, adjust to the specified value.
After the tyre inflation pressure has been adjusted, check the tyres for damage and air leaks. Be sure to put caps on the valves.
8-12 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The use of worn tyres can be very dangerous be- leakage, component seizure, or other seri-
cause of the greater chance of skidding or hydro- ous faults.
planing. The tread depth of the tyres must exceed
1.6 mm in order for the tyres to meet the minimum
requirement for use. Replacing tyres and wheels
If there are tread wear indicators on the tyres, they E01007200038
OCRE12E1 8-13
Maintenance
When rotating tyres, check for uneven wear and Snow tyres
damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused by incor- CAUTION E01002000725
rect tyre pressure, improper wheel alignment, out The use of snow tyres is recommended for driving
of balance wheel, or severe braking. We recom- l If the tyres have arrows (A) indicating
on snow and ice. To preserve driving stability,
the correct direction of rotation, swap the
mend you to have it checked to determine the mount snow tyres of the same size and tread pat-
front and rear wheels on the left hand
cause of irregular tread wear. tern on all 4 wheels.
side of the vehicle and the front and rear
Snow tyres worn more than 50% are no longer suit-
wheels on the right hand side of the vehi-
able for use as snow tyres.
Spare tyre used* cle separately. Keep each tyre on its origi-
Snow tyres which do not meet specifications must
nal side of the vehicle. When fitting the
not be used.
tyres, make sure the arrows point in the
direction in which the wheels will turn
when the vehicle moves forward. Any
Front
tyre whose arrow points in the wrong di- CAUTION
rection will not perform to its full poten- l Observe permissable maximum speed for
tial. your snow tyres and the legal speed limit.
Spare tyre not used
NOTE
Front
Front l The laws and regulations concerning snow
tyres (driving speed, required use, type, etc.)
vary. Find out and follow the laws and regu-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
lations in the area you intend to drive.
Tyres that have arrows showing rotation direction l If flange nuts are used on your vehicle,
change to tapered nuts when steel wheels are
used.
8-14 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
chains, take care that hands and other ard range, we recommend you to have it checked.
WARNING parts of your body are not injured by the
sharp edges of the vehicle body.
l DO NOT use a jack when fitting the l Install the chains only on the rear tyres
chains, as in thsee conditions, the tyres and tighten them as tightly as possible
may slip on the icy road causing the vehi- with the ends securely fastened.
cle to slip off the jack.
NOTE
CAUTION l The laws and regulations concerning the use
of tyre chains vary. Find out and follow the
l Practice fitting the chains before you laws and regulations of the area you're driv-
need them.
Don’t expect help from other people in
ing in.
In most countries, it is prohibited by law to
8
the cold. use tyre chains on roads without snow.
l Choose a clear straight stretch of road
where you can pull over and still be seen
while you are fitting the chains.
OCRE12E1 8-15
Maintenance
Brake pedal free play Parking brake lever stroke Type 2 (RHD)
E01002300281 E01002400527
Stop the engine, depress the brake pedal several Pull the parking brake lever up to check the num-
times, and press down the pedal with your fingers ber of “clicks” that the ratchet makes. One click rep-
until initial resistance is felt. This distance should resents a lever movement of one notch. The lever
be within the specified range. should move the specified number of notches for
normal brake application.
Type 1
A
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
If the brake pedal free play is not within the stand-
ard range, we recommend you to have it checked.
Type 2 (LHD)
WARNING
l Continued operation of the vehicle with
the parking brake lever out of adjust-
ment may result in the vehicle moving
when unattended.
8-16 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. Lift the wiper arm off the windscreen.
2. Pull the wiper blade until its stopper (A) dis-
RHD
engages from the hook (B). Then, pull the
wiper blade further to remove it.
NOTE
8
4. Insert the wiper blade into the arm, starting
l Do not allow the wiper arm to fall onto the
with the opposite end of the blade from the
windscreen; it could damage the glass.
stopper. Make sure the hook (B) is fitted cor-
rectly in the grooves in the blade.
3. Attach the retainers (C) to a new wiper blade.
OCRE12E1 8-17
Maintenance
NOTE 5. Push the wiper blade until the hook (B) en- General maintenance
l Do not allow the wiper arm to fall onto the gages securely with the stopper (A). E01002700113
windscreen; it could damage the glass.
Fuel, engine coolant, oil and exhaust
3. Attach the retainers (C) to a new wiper blade. gas leakage
Refer to the illustration to ensure that the re- Look under the body of your vehicle to check for
tainers are correctly aligned as you attach fuel, engine coolant, oil and exhaust gas leaks.
them.
WARNING
l If you see a suspicious fuel leak or if you
smell fuel, do not operate the vehicle; we
recommend you to call for assistance.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
fuses first. If there is no blown fuses, check the
lamp bulbs.
For information regarding the inspection and re-
placement of the fuses and the lamp bulbs, refer to
“Fuses” on page 8-20 and “Replacement of lamp
bulbs” on page 8-23.
If the fuses and bulbs are all OK, we recommend
4. Insert the wiper blade into the arm, starting you to have your vehicle checked and repaired.
with the opposite end of the blade from the
stopper. Make sure the hook (B) is fitted cor- Meter, gauge and indicator/warning
rectly in the grooves in the blade.
lamps operation
Run the engine to check the operation of all meters,
NOTE
8 l If retainers are not supplied with the new wip-
gauges, and indicator/warning lamps.
If there is anything wrong, we recommend you to
er blade, use the retainers from the old blade. have your vehicle inspected.
8-18 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Hinges and latches lubrication For cold and snowy weather Fusible links
Check all latches and hinges, and lubricate if neces- E01002800257 E01002900030
sary by first cleaning and then applying multipur- The fusible links will melt to prevent a fire if a
pose grease. Ventilation slots large current attempts to flow through certain elec-
The ventilation slots in front of the windscreen trical systems.
should be kept clear of leaves or brushed clear after In case of a melted fusible link, we recommend
heavy snowfall, so that the operation of the heating you to have your vehicle inspected.
and ventilation systems will not be impaired.
Weatherstripping
To prevent freezing of the weatherstripping on the
doors, bonnet, etc., they should be treated with sili-
cone grease or spray.
Additional equipment
It is a good idea to carry a shovel or a short-han-
dled spade in the vehicle during the winter so that
you can clear away snow if you get stranded. A
small hand-brush for sweeping snow off the vehi-
cle and a plastic scraper for the windscreen and
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
rear window are also useful.
OCRE12E1 8-19
Maintenance
Passenger compartment
The fuse block in the passenger compartment is lo-
cated in front of the driver’s seat at the position
shown in the illustration.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The fuse capacity and the name of the electrical sys-
tems protected by the fuses are indicated on the in-
side of the fuse lid located at the driver’s leg area
and on the inside of the fuse block cover for fuses
located in the engine compartment.
Passenger compartment fuse location table
E01007900501
RHD
NOTE
l Spare fuses are contained in the fuse lid. Al-
ways use a fuse of the same capacity for re-
placement.
8
8-20 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
9 28 — Spare fuse 20 A
Engine control unit 7.5 A
29 — Spare fuse 30 A
10 Control unit 7.5 A
l Some fuses may not be installed on your ve-
11 Rear fog lamp 10 A hicle, depending on the vehicle model or spec-
ifications.
12 Central door lock 15 A l The table above shows the main equipment
corresponding to each fuse.
13 Room lamp 10 A The fuse block does not contain spare 10 A
and 15 A fuses. If a fuse of one of these ca-
14 Rear window wiper 15 A pacities blows, replace it temporarily by bor-
15 Gauge 7.5 A rowing the one that matches from:
10 A: Radio
16 Relay 7.5 A 15 A: Cigarette lighter
Replace the borrowed fuse as soon as possible.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
17 Heated seat 20 A
18 Option 10 A
Ca- 19 Heated door mirror 7.5 A
No. Symbol Electrical system
pacity
1 Tail lamp (left) 7.5 A 20 Windscreen wiper 20 A
OCRE12E1 8-21
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Hazard warning flasher (A).
15 10 A
8-22 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
CAUTION
l Bulbs are extremely hot immediately af-
ter being turned off.
4. Referring to the fuse load capacity table, When replacing a bulb, wait for it to cool
check the fuse pertaining to the problem. sufficiently before touching it. You could
otherwise be burnt.
CAUTION NOTE
l If you are unsure of how to carry out the
l If the newly inserted fuse blows again af- work as required, we recommend you to con-
ter a short time, we recommend you to
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
sult a specialist.
have the electrical system checked to find l Be careful not to scratch the vehicle body
the cause and rectify it. when removing a lamp or lens.
l Never use a fuse with a capacity larger l When it rains or when the vehicle has been
than that specified or any substitute, such washed, the inside of the lens sometimes be-
as wire, foil, etc.; doing so will cause the comes foggy. This is the same phenomenon
circuit wiring to heat up and could cause as when window glass mists up on a humid
C- Fuse is OK a fire. day, and does not indicate a functional prob-
D- Blown fuse lem. When the lamp is switched on, the heat
will remove the fog. However, if water gath-
NOTE ers inside the lamp, we recommend you to
l If any system does not function but the fuse have the lamp checked.
corresponding to that system is normal, there
may be a fault in the system elsewhere. We
recommend you to have your vehicle checked.
Bulb capacity 8
E01003200085
When replacing a bulb, use a new bulb with the
same wattage and colour.
OCRE12E1 8-23
Maintenance
Single cab
Front (Type 1) Codes in parentheses indicate bulb types.
Rear
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
6- Front fog lamps*: 55 W (H11)
Front (Type 2)
8-24 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Club cab Headlamps 2. Depress the tab (B) on the harness connector
E01003501375 and pull the harness connector (C) to remove
it.
Type 1
1. Remove the bulb and connector assembly
High beam Low beam
(A) by turning it anticlockwise.
High beam
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Double cab
OCRE12E1 8-25
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
4. To install the bulb, perform the removal
steps in reverse.
8-26 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
2. To install the bulb, perform the removal move it. And remove the bulb from the sock-
steps in reverse. Front turn-signal lamps et by turning it anticlockwise while pressing
E01003800818
in.
Type 1
1. Turn the bulb socket anticlockwise to re-
move it. And remove the bulb from the sock-
OCRE12E1 8-27
Maintenance
2. To install the bulb, perform the removal 2. Remove the socket and bulb assembly togeth- Front fog lamps*
steps in reverse. er by turning it anticlockwise, and then re- E01004001537
move the bulb by pulling out. 1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
with a cloth over its tip at the edge of the cov-
Side turn-signal lamps er and pry gently to remove the cover.
E01003900037
1. To remove a side turn-signal lamp, insert a
straight blade (or minus) screwdriver at the Type 1
end of the lamp nearer the front of the body
and use it to gently lever the lamp out of the
body.
Front
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l When replacing the lamp assembly, push in
the end facing the rear of the vehicle first.
NOTE
l Wrap a piece of cloth around the tip of the Front
screwdriver in order to avoid scratching the
lens and the body.
8-28 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
2. Turn the 3 bolts (A) anticlockwise to remove 4. Turn the entire socket and bulb assembly (D)
them. And then remove the lamp assembly. anticlockwise to remove it.
3. Depress the tab (B) on the harness connector 5. To install the bulb, perform the removal Type 1 (Driver’s side only)
and pull the harness connector (C) to remove steps in reverse. 1. Remove the screws (A) from the rear fog
it. lamp lens, and then remove the lens (B).
CAUTION
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
l Handle halogen lamp bulbs with care.
The gas inside halogen lamp bulbs is high-
ly pressurized, so dropping, knocking, or
scratching a halogen lamp bulb can cause
it to shatter.
l Never hold the halogen lamp bulb with a
bare hand, dirty glove, etc.
The oil from your hand could cause the
bulb to break the next time the fog lamps
are operated.
If the glass surface is dirty, it must be
cleaned with alcohol, paint thinner, etc.,
and refit it after drying thoroughly. 8
OCRE12E1 8-29
Maintenance
2. Remove the bulb (C) by turning it anticlock- Rear combination lamps 4. Remove each socket and bulb assembly by
wise while pressing it inward. E01004200763 turning it anticlockwise.
1. Open the rear gate.
(Refer to “Rear gate” on page 1-13.)
2. Remove the screws (A) that hold the lamp unit.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
turning it anticlockwise, and then remove the
E- Reversing lamp
bulb by pulling out.
Remove the bulb by pulling it out.
NOTE
l When mounting the lamp unit, align the pins
(F) and clip (G) on the lamp unit with the
holes (H) in the body.
8
2. To install the bulb, perform the removal
steps in reverse.
8-30 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
E01004600969
3. To install the bulb, perform the removal
Type 1 steps in reverse.
1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
into the lamp assembly and pry gently to re- NOTE
move it.
l When mounting the lamp unit, put the hook
(A) on the right side of the lamp unit into the
body first.
OCRE12E1 8-31
Maintenance
NOTE
l When installing the lens, align the 2 tabs on
the lens with the holes on the vehicle side.
Type 2
1. Remove the screws (A) from the lamp unit,
and then remove the lens and cover.
3. To install the bulb, perform the removal
steps in reverse.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
into the notch of the lens and pry gently to re-
move it.
Remove the bulb from the lamp holder.
Type 1
1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
into the notch of the lens and pry gently to re-
8-32 OCRE12E1
Maintenance
move it. Remove the bulb from the lamp hold- NOTE
er. l When installing the lens, align the 2 tabs on
the lens with the holes on the vehicle side.
Type 2
1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
into the notch of the lens and pry gently to re-
move it. Remove the bulb from the lamp hold-
NOTE er.
l Wrap a piece of cloth around the tip of the Door courtesy lamps*
screwdriver in order to avoid scratching the E01005400238
lens. 1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
into the lens and pry gently to remove it. Re-
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
2. To install the bulb, perform the removal move the bulb from the lamp holder.
steps in reverse.
NOTE
l When installing the lens, fit the two tabs on
one side of the lens into the holes on the vehi-
cle side before fitting the two tabs on the op-
posite side of the lens into the holes on the ve-
hicle side.
NOTE
l Wrap a piece of cloth around the tip of the
screwdriver in order to avoid scratching the
lens.
8
2. To install the bulb, perform the removal
steps in reverse.
OCRE12E1 8-33
Maintenance
NOTE Centre console downlight 2. Turn the bulb socket (B) anticlockwise to re-
l Wrap a piece of cloth around the tip of the E01008700144 move it.
screwdriver in order to avoid scratching the
lens. Type 1 Type 2
NOTE
l When installing the lens, align the 2 tabs on
the lens with the holes on the vehicle side.
Type 2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
1. Insert a straight blade (or minus) screwdriver
with a cloth over its tip at edge of the garnish
(A) and pry gently to remove it.
8-34 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Vehicle labeling............................................................................9-02
Vehicle dimensions.......................................................................9-03
Vehicle performance.....................................................................9-09
Vehicle weight..............................................................................9-10
Engine specifications....................................................................9-15
Transmission specifications..........................................................9-16
Electrical system...........................................................................9-17
Tyres and wheels..........................................................................9-18
Other specifications......................................................................9-19
Fuel consumption.........................................................................9-20
Refill capacities............................................................................9-22
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
OCRE12E1
Specifications
1- Model code
2- Engine model code
3- Transmission model code
4- Body colour code
5- Interior code
Vehicle information code plate 6- Option code Engine number
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
The vehicle information code plate is located as The engine number is stamped on the engine cylin-
shown in the illustration. der block as shown in the illustration.
9-02 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Vehicle dimensions
E01100202597
Single cab
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
OCRE12E1 9-03
Specifications
Single cab
Item 2WD 4WD
1 Front track 1,505 mm
2 Overall width 1,750 mm
3 Front overhang 830 mm
4 Wheel base 3,000 mm
5 Rear overhang Without rear bumper 1,210 mm
With rear bumper 1,385 mm
6 Overall length Without rear bumper 5,040 mm
With rear bumper 5,215 mm
7 Ground clearance (unladen) 200 mm
8 Overall height (unladen) 1,655 mm 1,775 mm
9 Rear track 1,500 mm
10 Cargo bed length 2,220 mm
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
11 Cargo bed width 1,470 mm
12 Cargo bed height 715 mm 845 mm
9
9-04 OCRE12E1
Club cab
OCRE12E1
9-05
Specifications
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Specifications
Club cab
Item Easy select 4WD Super select 4WD
1 Front track 1,505 mm 1,520 mm
2 Overall width 1,750 mm 1,815 mm
3 Front overhang 795 mm, 830 mm*1
4 Wheel base 3,000 mm
Without rear bumper 1,325 mm
5 Rear overhang
With rear bumper 1,400 mm
6 Without rear bumper 5,120 mm, 5,155 mm*1
Overall length
With rear bumper 5,195 mm, 5,230 mm*1
7 Ground clearance (unladen) 200 mm 205 mm
8 Overall height (unladen) 1,775 mm, 1,790 mm*2 1,780 mm
9 Rear track 1,500 mm 1,515 mm
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
10 Cargo bed length 1,805 mm
11 Cargo bed width 1,470 mm
12 Cargo bed height 855 mm 860 mm
*1: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
*2: Vehicles with rear guard frame
9
9-06 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Double cab
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
OCRE12E1 9-07
Specifications
Double cab
Item 2WD and Easy select 4WD Super select 4WD
1 Front track 1,505 mm 1,520 mm
2 Overall width 1,750 mm 1,815 mm, 1,800 mm*1
3 Front overhang 795 mm, 830 mm*1,*2
4 Wheel base 3,000 mm
Without rear bumper 1,210 mm, 1,390 mm*3
5 Rear overhang
With rear bumper 1,285 mm, 1,465 mm*3
6 Without rear bumper 5,005 mm, 5,185 mm*3, 5,040 mm*1,*2, 5,220 mm*4,*5
Overall length
With rear bumper 5,080 mm, 5,260 mm*3, 5,115 mm*1, 5,295 mm*4
7 Ground clearance (unladen) 200 mm 205 mm
8 Overall height (unladen) 1,775 mm, 1,655 mm*2 1,780 mm
9 Rear track 1,500 mm 1,515 mm
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
10 Cargo bed length 1,325 mm, 1,505 mm*3
11 Cargo bed width 1,470 mm
12 Cargo bed height 845 mm, 715 mm*2 850 mm
*1: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
*2: 2WD vehicles with 15 inch tyres
*3: Vehicles with long bed
*4: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine with long bed
*5: 2WD vehicles with 15 inch tyres and long bed
9
9-08 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Vehicle performance
E01100301966
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
OCRE12E1 9-09
Specifications
Vehicle weight
E01100404900
Single cab
4WD
Item 2WD
LHD RHD
Without optional parts 1,565 kg, 1,550 kg *1 1,780 kg 1,770 kg
Kerb weight
With full optional parts 1,595 kg, 1,600 kg *1 1,840 kg 1,810 kg
Maximum gross vehicle weight 2,630 kg 2,850 kg 2,890 kg
Front 1,030 kg 1,260 kg
Maximum axle weight
Rear 1,700 kg 1,800 kg
With brake 1,800 kg *2 2,700 kg
Maximum towable weight
Without brake 750 kg *2
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Maximum permissible weight of the coupling device 35 kg*2 45 kg*3
Seating capacity (including a driver) 2 persons, 3 persons*4
*1: Vehicles for Morocco
*2: Except for vehicles for Morocco
*3: Crossmember (weight = 10 kg) must be dismounted
*4: Vehicles equipped with bench seat
NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.
l When loading luggage and/or towing a trailer, make sure not to exceed any of the above maximum weights all the time.
9
9-10 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Club cab
Easy select 4WD
Item Super select 4WD
LHD RHD
Kerb weight Without optional parts 1,800 kg 1,800 kg 1,815 kg, 1,825 kg *1
With full optional parts 1,900 kg 1,880 kg 1,910 kg, 1,920 kg *1
Maximum gross vehicle weight 2,850 kg
Maximum axle weight Front 1,260 kg
Rear 1,800 kg
Maximum towable weight With brake 2,700 kg
Without brake 750 kg
Maximum trailer-nose weight 115 kg
Maximum gross combination weight 5,500 kg
Maximum permissible weight of the coupling device 45 kg*2
Seating capacity (including a driver) 4 persons
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
*1: Vehicles with high power engine
*2: Crossmember (weight = 10 kg) must be dismounted
NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.
l When loading luggage and/or towing a trailer, make sure not to exceed any of the above maximum weights all the time.
9
OCRE12E1 9-11
Specifications
Double cab
2WD
M/T
Item
Vehicles with 15 inch Vehicles with 16 inch A/T
tyres tyres
Kerb weight Without optional parts 1,665 kg 1,770 kg 1,780 kg
With full optional parts 1,735 kg 1,900 kg 1,910 kg
Maximum gross vehicle weight 2,630 kg 2,800 kg
Maximum axle weight Front 1,030 kg 1,260 kg
Rear 1,700 kg 1,800 kg
Maximum towable weight With brake 1,800 kg 2,700 kg
Without brake 750 kg
Maximum trailer-nose weight 75 kg 112 kg
Maximum gross combination weight 4,400 kg 5,465 kg
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Maximum permissible weight of the coupling device 35 kg 45 kg*
Seating capacity (including a driver) 5 persons
*: Crossmember (weight = 10 kg) must be dismounted
NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.
l When loading luggage and/or towing a trailer, make sure not to exceed any of the above maximum weights all the time.
9
9-12 OCRE12E1
Specifications
4WD
Easy select 4WD Super select 4WD
Item
M/T M/T A/T
A/T
LHD RHD LHD RHD LHD RHD
Kerb weight Without optional parts 1,870 kg, 1,850 kg 1,880 kg 1,890 kg, 1,885 kg 1,915 kg, 1,885 kg,
1,860 kg *1 1,900 kg*2, 1,890 kg *1 1,900 kg *2
1,880 kg*1
With full optional parts 2,000 kg, 1,980 kg 2,010 kg 2,030 kg, 2,030 kg 2,045 kg, 2,030 kg,
1,980 kg *1 2,040 kg*2, 2,025 kg *1 2,045 kg *2
2,015 kg*1
Maximum gross vehicle weight 2,850 kg 2,900 kg 2,930 kg 2,850 kg 2,930 kg,
2,850 kg
2,945 kg *2
Maximum axle weight Front 1,260 kg
Rear 1,800 kg
Maximum towable weight With brake 2,700 kg
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Without brake 750 kg
Maximum trailer-nose weight 115 kg
5,580 kg,
Maximum gross combination weight 5,500 kg 5,550 kg 5,500 kg 5,580 kg 5,500 kg
5,595 kg *2
Maximum permissible weight of the coupling
45 kg*3
device
Seating capacity (including a driver) 5 persons
*1: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
*2: Vehicles with high power engine
*3: Crossmember (weight = 10 kg) must be dismounted
9
OCRE12E1 9-13
Specifications
NOTE
l Trailer specifications indicate the manufacturer’s recommendation.
l When loading luggage and/or towing a trailer, make sure not to exceed any of the above maximum weights all the time.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
9-14 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Engine specifications
E01100602692
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Exhaust 0.14 mm (cold)
Maximum output (EEC net) 94 kW/4,000 r/min 100 kW/4,000 r/min, 100 131 kW/3,750 r/min
kW/3,500 r/min*2
Maximum torque (EEC net) 240 Nm/1,500 to 314 Nm/2,000 r/min 400 Nm/2,000 to 350 Nm/1,800 to
3,500 r/min 2,850 r/min 3,500 r/min
*1: Vehicles to comply with the Euro 3 or Euro 4 regulation
*2: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
9
OCRE12E1 9-15
Specifications
Transmission specifications
E01100701553
M/T A/T
2WD 4WD 4WD
Item Super select 4WD Super select 4WD
Vehicles Vehicles 2WD
Easy select Easy select
with 15 inch with 16 inch High power Standard
4WD 4WD 4A/T 5A/T
tyres tyres engine power engine
Transmission 1st gear ratio 4.313 2.842 3.789
2nd gear ratio 2.330 1.495 2.057
3rd gear ratio 1.436 1.000 1.421
4th gear ratio 1.000 0.731 1.000
5th gear ratio 0.788 — 0.731
Reverse gear 4.220 2.720 3.865
ratio
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Transfer High gear ra- — 1.000 — 1.000 1.000
tio
Low gear ra- — 1.900 — 1.900 1.900
tio
Final gear ratio 3.909 3.917 3.917 3.917 3.917, 4.100* 3.917 3.917 4.100 3.917
*: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
9
9-16 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Electrical system
E01100802391
Voltage 12 V
Battery Type (JIS) 95D31L 80D26L*
Capacity (5HR) 64 Ah 55 Ah*
Alternator capacity Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan, Uk- 90 A 120 A*
raine, Morocco and Turkey
Except for vehicles for Russia, Kazakh- 95 A 130 A*
stan, Ukraine, Morocco and Turkey
*: Optional equipment
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
OCRE12E1 9-17
Specifications
Tyre 195R15C 106/104R 8PR, 205/80R16 104S RF, 245/70R16 111S RF 245/65R17 111S RF
215/70R15C 109/107R* 205R16C 110/108R 8PR
Wheel Size 15x6JJ 16x6JJ 16x7J 17x7 1/2J
Offset 46 mm 38 mm
*: On vehicles with 195 size tyres, this size of snow tyres can also be used instead.
NOTE
l Contact your MITSUBISHI MOTORS Authorized Service Point for details on the combination used on your vehicle.
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
9-18 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Other specifications
E01101000862
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
9
OCRE12E1 9-19
Specifications
Fuel consumption
E01101100717
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
A/T Standard 222, 229*1 8.4, 8.6*1 10.2, 11.0*1 7.4, 7.3*1
Full option 227, 234*1 8.6, 8.8*1 10.5, 11.2*1 7.6, 7.5*1
4WD M/T Standard 199, 215*1, 218*2, 7.5, 8.1*1, 8.3*2, 8.9, 10.3*1, 10.4*2, 6.8, 6.9*1, 7.1*2,*3
221*3 8.4*3 10.6*3
Full option 208, 223*1, 229*3 7.9, 8.5*1, 8.7*3 9.2, 10.5*1, 10.9*3 7.2, 7.3*1, 7.4*3
A/T Standard 222, 240*3 8.4, 9.0*3 10.2, 11.7*3 7.4, 7.5*3
Full option 234, 246*3 8.9, 9.3*3 10.8, 12.1*3 7.8, 7.7*3
*1: Vehicles for Turkey and Morocco
*2: Vehicles for Turkey with wide fender
*3: Vehicles for Russia, Kazakhstan and Ukraine
9
9-20 OCRE12E1
Specifications
NOTE
l The results given do not express or imply any guarantee of the fuel consumption of the particular vehicle.
The vehicle itself has not been tested and there are inevitably differences between individual vehicles of the same model. In addition, this vehicle may incor-
porate particular modifications. Furthermore, the driver’s style and road and traffic conditions, as well as the extent to which the vehicle has been driven and
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
the standard of maintenance, will all affect its fuel consumption.
9
OCRE12E1 9-21
Specifications
Refill capacities
E01101303866
LHD
M/T A/T
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
RHD M/T A/T
9
9-22 OCRE12E1
Specifications
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
8
sion oil 4WD 3.4 litres 75W-85
Gear oil API classification GL-3 SAE
9 Transfer oil 2.5 litres 75W-85 or Gear oil API classification
GL-4 SAE 75W-85
Front*2 1.2 litres
Standard power en- 2WD with 15 inch tyres 1.5 litres Gear oil API classification GL-5 or
10 Differential oil
Rear gine 2WD with 16 inch tyres, 4WD higher SAE 80W
2.1 litres
High power engine
480-520 g,
11 Refrigerant (air conditioning) HFC-134a
535-575 g*3
*1: Vehicles with “front (Type 1)” (Refer to “Outside” on page 8-24)
*2: 4WD vehicles only
*3: Double cab with capacity up air conditioning 9
OCRE12E1 9-23
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Alphabetical index
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Armrest (Double cab) 2-07 Parking brake lever stroke 8-16 Curtain airbag system 2-35
Ashtray 5-70 Pedal free play 8-16
Audio Warning lamp 3-08 D
Audio system anti-theft feature 5-48
Error codes 5-42 C Demister (rear window) 3-40
Handling of compact discs 5-48 Diesel particulate filter (DPF) 4-14
LW/MW/FM electronic tuning radio with CD Cargo loads 4-54 Differential oil 9-22
player 5-13 Catalytic converter 8-02 Digital clock 3-19,5-73
Steering wheel remote control switch 5-40 Cautions on handling of 4-wheel drive vehi- Dimensions 9-03
Automatic air conditioning 5-08 cles 4-41 Dipper (High/Low beam change) 3-31
Automatic transmission 4A/T 4-17 Central door locks 1-07 Door courtesy lamps 5-75
Fluid 8-07,9-22 Centre console downlight 5-75 Replacement 8-33
Overdrive control switch 4-18 Bulb capacity 8-24 Doors
Selector lever operation 4-17,4-21 Replacement 8-34 Central door locks 1-07
Selector lever position 4-18 Centre information display 3-10 Child-protection 1-08
Selector lever position indicator 4-17 Changing a fuse 8-22 Lock and unlock 1-06
Automatic transmission Sports Mode 5A/T 4-21 Changing gears 4-15 Driving, alcohol and drugs 4-02
Fluid 8-07,9-22 Check engine warning lamp 3-08
OCRE12E1 1
Alphabetical index
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Error codes 5-42 Fuses 8-20 I
Exterior and interior lamp operation 8-18 Fusible links 8-19
If the vehicle breaks down 6-02
F G Ignition switch 4-11
Indication and warning lamps 3-06
First-aid kit and warning triangle band for secur- Gauges 3-02 Indication lamps 3-07
ing 5-80 General maintenance 8-18 Inside rear-view mirror 4-09
Floor console box 5-76 General vehicle data 9-03 Inspection and maintenance following rough road
Fluid Genuine parts 05 operation 4-41
Automatic transmission fluid 8-07,9-22 Glove box 5-76 Installation of accessories 04
Brake fluid 8-08,9-22 Glove box lamp Instruments 3-02
Clutch fluid 8-09,9-22 Bulb capacity 8-24 Interior lamps 5-73
Engine coolant 8-06,9-22 Replacement 8-34
Power steering fluid 8-09,9-22 J
Washer fluid 8-08,9-22 H
For cold and snowy weather 8-19 Jack handle 6-12
Front console box 5-76 Handling of compact discs 5-48 Storage 6-07
Front fog lamps Hazard warning flasher switch 3-34 Jacking up the vehicle 6-13
2 OCRE12E1
Alphabetical index
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Link System 5-51 Replacement 8-32 Removal of water from the fuel filter 6-06
Low fuel warning lamp 3-04 Position lamps Replacement of lamp bulbs 8-23
Lubricants 9-22 Bulb capacity 8-24 Reversing lamps
LW/MW/FM electronic tuning radio with CD play- Replacement 8-27 Bulb capacity 8-24
er 5-13 Power steering Replacement 8-30
Fluid 8-09,9-22 Room lamp 5-73,5-74
Running-in recommendations 4-04
M System 4-47
Precautions to observe when using wipers and wash-
Manual transmission 4-15 ers 3-39 S
Oil 9-22 Pregnant women restraint 2-11
Manual window control 1-08 Puncture (Tyre changing) 6-17 Safe driving techniques 4-03
Mirror Seat belt 2-09
Inside rear-view mirror 4-09 R Adjustable seat belt anchor 2-11
Child restraint 2-13
Outside rear-view mirrors 4-10
Vanity mirror 5-70 Radio Inspection 2-27
Modification/alterations to the electrical or fuel sys- LW/MW/FM electronic tuning radio with CD Pregnant women restraint 2-11
tems 04 player 5-13 Pretensioner 2-12
Rear combination lamps Seat belt reminder/warning lamp 2-10
OCRE12E1 3
Alphabetical index
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
Power steering fluid 8-09,9-22 T 4-21 Vehicle weight 9-10
Power steering system 4-47 Fluid 8-07,9-22 Ventilators 5-02
Steering wheel height adjustment 4-09 Manual transmission 4-15
Steering wheel lock 4-12
Steering wheel remote control switch 5-40
Specifications 9-16
Tripmeter 3-03
W
Stop lamps Turn-signal indication lamps 3-07 Warning lamps 3-08
Bulb capacity 8-23 Turn-signals lever 3-33 Washer
Replacement 8-30 Tyres 8-11 Fluid 8-08,9-22
Storage spaces 5-75 How to change a tyre 6-17 Switch 3-36,3-39
Sun visors 5-69 Inflation pressures 8-12 Washing 7-03
Sunglasses holder 5-77 Rotation 8-13 Water temperature gauge 3-05
Sunroof 1-13 Size (tyre and wheel) 9-18 Waxing 7-04
Safety mechanism 1-14 Snow tyres 8-14 Weatherstripping 8-19
Sunshade 1-14 Tyre chains 8-14 Weight 9-10
Switch 1-13 Wheel condition 8-13 Wheel condition 8-13
Super select 4WD 4-30
Wheel
Supplemental restraint system 2-27
Specification 9-18
Wiper
4 OCRE12E1
Alphabetical index
Switch 3-36
Wiper blade rubber replacement 8-17
Wiper blades 8-17
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1 5
6
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
7
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
8
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
9
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
10
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
11
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©
OCRE12E1
Presented by http://mmc-manuals.ru/ ©